3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle GNU Coreutils
5 @documentencoding UTF-8
11 @include constants.texi
13 @c Define new indices.
17 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
27 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
28 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
29 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
30 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
33 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
34 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
35 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
37 @dircategory Individual utilities
39 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
40 * b2sum: (coreutils)b2sum invocation. Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
41 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
42 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
43 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
44 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
45 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
46 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
47 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
48 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
49 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
50 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
51 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
52 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
53 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
54 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
55 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
56 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
57 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
58 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
59 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
60 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
61 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
62 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
63 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
64 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
65 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
66 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
67 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
68 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
69 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
70 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
71 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
72 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
73 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
74 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
75 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
76 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
77 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
78 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
79 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
80 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
81 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
82 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
83 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
84 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
85 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
86 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
87 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
88 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
89 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
90 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
91 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
92 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
93 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
94 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
95 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
96 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
97 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
98 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
99 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
100 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
101 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
102 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
103 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
104 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
105 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
106 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
107 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
108 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
109 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
110 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
111 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
112 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
113 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
114 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
115 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
116 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
117 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
118 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory to disk.
119 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
120 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
121 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
122 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
123 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
124 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
125 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
126 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
127 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
128 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
129 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
130 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
131 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
132 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
133 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
134 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
135 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
136 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
137 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
138 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
139 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
140 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
144 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
145 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
147 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
150 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
151 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
152 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
153 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
154 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
155 Free Documentation License''.
160 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
161 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
162 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
163 @author David MacKenzie et al.
166 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
179 @cindex core utilities
180 @cindex text utilities
181 @cindex shell utilities
182 @cindex file utilities
185 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
186 * Common options:: Common options
187 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64
188 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
189 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
190 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum b2sum md5sum sha1sum sha2
191 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
192 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
193 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
194 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
195 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
196 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
197 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
198 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
199 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
200 * Conditions:: false true test expr
202 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
203 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
204 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
205 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
206 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
207 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
208 * Process control:: kill
210 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
211 * File permissions:: Access modes
212 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
213 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
214 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
215 * Concept index:: General index
218 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
222 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
223 * Backup options:: Backup options
224 * Block size:: Block size
225 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
226 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
227 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
228 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
229 * Target directory:: Target directory
230 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
231 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
232 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
233 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
234 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
236 Output of entire files
238 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
239 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
240 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
241 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
242 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
243 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
245 Formatting file contents
247 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
248 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
249 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
251 Output of parts of files
253 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
254 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
255 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
256 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
260 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
261 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
262 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
263 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
264 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
265 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
266 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
268 Operating on sorted files
270 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
271 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
272 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
273 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
274 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
275 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
277 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
279 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
280 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
281 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
282 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
283 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
287 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
288 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
289 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
291 Operating on characters
293 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
294 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
295 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
297 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
299 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters
300 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
301 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters
305 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
306 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
307 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
308 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
310 @command{ls}: List directory contents
312 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
313 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
314 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
315 * Details about version sort:: More details about version sort
316 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
317 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
321 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
322 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
323 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
324 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
325 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
326 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
330 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
331 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
332 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
333 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
334 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
335 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
336 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
337 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
339 Changing file attributes
341 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
342 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
343 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
344 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
348 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
349 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
350 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
351 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
352 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
356 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
357 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
358 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
362 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
363 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
364 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
365 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
367 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
369 * File type tests:: File type tests
370 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
371 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
372 * String tests:: String tests
373 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
375 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
377 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
378 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
379 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
380 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
384 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
386 File name manipulation
388 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
389 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
390 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
391 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
392 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
396 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
397 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
398 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
399 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
401 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
403 * Control:: Control settings
404 * Input:: Input settings
405 * Output:: Output settings
406 * Local:: Local settings
407 * Combination:: Combination settings
408 * Characters:: Special characters
409 * Special:: Special settings
413 * id invocation:: Print user identity
414 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
415 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
416 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
417 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
418 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
422 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
423 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
424 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
425 * uname invocation:: Print system information
426 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
427 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
428 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
430 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
432 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
433 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
434 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
435 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
436 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
437 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
438 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
439 * Examples of date:: Examples
443 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
444 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
446 Modified command invocation
448 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
449 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
450 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
451 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
452 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
453 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
457 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
461 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
465 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
466 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
467 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
471 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
472 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
473 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
474 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
478 * General date syntax:: Common rules
479 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994
480 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm
481 * Time zone items:: EST, PDT, UTC, @dots{}
482 * Combined date and time of day items:: 1972-09-24T20:02:00,000000-0500
483 * Day of week items:: Monday and others
484 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago
485 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440
486 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502
487 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0"
488 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
490 Opening the software toolbox
492 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
493 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
494 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
495 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
496 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
497 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
498 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
502 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
509 @chapter Introduction
511 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
512 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
513 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
517 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
519 @cindex bugs, reporting
521 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}.
522 Include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
523 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
524 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong.
526 If you have a problem with @command{sort} or @command{date}, try using the
527 @option{--debug} option, as it can can often help find and fix problems without
528 having to wait for an answer to a bug report. If the debug output
529 does not suffice to fix the problem on your own, please compress and
530 attach it to the rest of your bug report.
532 Although diffs are welcome,
533 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
534 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
540 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
543 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
544 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
545 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
546 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
547 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
548 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
549 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
550 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
551 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
552 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
553 insights to the overall process.
556 @chapter Common options
560 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
563 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
564 @cindex backups, making
565 @xref{Backup options}.
566 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
569 @macro optBackupSuffix
570 @item -S @var{suffix}
571 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
574 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
575 @xref{Backup options}.
578 @macro optTargetDirectory
579 @item -t @var{directory}
580 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
582 @opindex --target-directory
583 @cindex target directory
584 @cindex destination directory
585 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
586 @xref{Target directory}.
589 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
591 @itemx --no-target-directory
593 @opindex --no-target-directory
594 @cindex target directory
595 @cindex destination directory
596 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
597 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
601 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
602 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
603 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
604 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
623 @macro optZeroTerminated
625 @itemx --zero-terminated
627 @opindex --zero-terminated
628 @cindex process zero-terminated items
629 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
630 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
631 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
632 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
633 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
634 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
635 or other special characters).
642 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
643 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
644 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
645 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
646 @option{--human-readable} option if
647 you prefer powers of 1024.
650 @macro optHumanReadable
652 @itemx --human-readable
654 @opindex --human-readable
655 @cindex human-readable output
656 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
657 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
658 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
659 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
662 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
663 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
664 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
665 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
666 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
667 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
670 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
671 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
672 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
673 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
674 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
675 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
676 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
681 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
682 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
683 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
685 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
686 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
687 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
688 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
689 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
690 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
691 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
693 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
696 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
697 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
698 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
699 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
701 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
702 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
703 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
704 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
705 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
706 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
708 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
711 @cindex common options
713 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
714 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
715 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
718 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
719 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
720 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
721 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
722 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
723 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
724 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
726 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
727 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
728 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
729 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
730 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
731 specify a command that itself contains options.
733 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
734 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
735 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
736 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
737 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
739 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
740 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
741 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
748 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
752 @cindex version number, finding
753 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
757 @cindex option delimiter
758 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
759 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
760 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
764 @cindex standard input
765 @cindex standard output
766 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
767 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
768 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
769 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
770 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
774 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
775 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
776 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
777 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
778 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
779 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
780 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
781 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
782 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
783 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
784 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
785 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
786 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
787 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
795 An exit status of zero indicates success,
796 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
799 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
800 that can be used to change how other commands work.
801 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
802 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
803 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
804 requires only that it be nonzero.
806 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
807 other exit status values and a few associate different
808 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
809 Here are some of the exceptions:
810 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{nice},
811 @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort},
812 @command{stdbuf}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
816 @section Backup options
818 @cindex backup options
820 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
821 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
822 before writing new versions.
823 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
824 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
829 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
832 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
833 @cindex backups, making
834 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
835 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
836 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
837 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
838 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
839 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
840 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
842 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
843 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
845 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
846 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
847 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
848 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
849 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
854 @opindex none @r{backup method}
859 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
860 Always make numbered backups.
864 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
865 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
870 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
871 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
872 confused with @samp{none}.
876 @item -S @var{suffix}
877 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
880 @cindex backup suffix
881 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
882 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
883 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
884 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
885 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
894 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
895 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
896 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
897 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
898 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
900 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
903 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
904 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
905 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
906 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
908 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
909 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
914 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
915 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
916 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
919 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
920 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
923 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
924 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
925 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
926 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
927 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
930 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
931 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
932 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
937 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
938 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
939 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
942 @cindex human-readable output
945 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
946 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
947 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
948 that are upward compatible with the
949 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
951 for decimal multiples and with the
952 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
953 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
955 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
956 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
957 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
958 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
959 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
962 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
963 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
964 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
965 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
966 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
967 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
970 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
971 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
972 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
973 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
974 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
975 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
976 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
978 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
979 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
980 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
983 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
984 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
988 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
989 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
993 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
994 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
995 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
996 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
998 @cindex megabyte, definition of
999 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
1002 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
1003 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
1005 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
1006 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
1009 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1010 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1012 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1013 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1016 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1017 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1019 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1020 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1023 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1024 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1026 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1027 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1030 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1031 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1033 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1034 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1037 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1039 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1040 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1043 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1048 @opindex --block-size
1049 @opindex --human-readable
1052 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1053 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1054 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1055 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1056 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1057 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1058 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1059 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1060 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1062 @node Floating point
1063 @section Floating point numbers
1064 @cindex floating point
1065 @cindex IEEE floating point
1067 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1068 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1069 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1070 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1071 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1072 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1073 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1074 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1075 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1076 @uref{http://@/www.validlab.com/@/goldberg/@/paper.pdf, What Every
1077 Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1080 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1081 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1082 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1083 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1084 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1085 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1086 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1087 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1088 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1089 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
1090 locale determines the decimal-point character. @xref{Parsing of
1091 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1093 @node Signal specifications
1094 @section Signal specifications
1095 @cindex signals, specifying
1097 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1098 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1099 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1100 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1101 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1107 2. Terminal interrupt.
1113 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1121 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1122 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1123 support the following signals:
1127 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1129 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1131 Continue executing, if stopped.
1133 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1135 Illegal Instruction.
1137 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1139 Invalid memory reference.
1141 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1145 Background process attempting read.
1147 Background process attempting write.
1149 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1151 User-defined signal 1.
1153 User-defined signal 2.
1157 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1158 also support the following signals:
1164 Profiling timer expired.
1168 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1170 Virtual timer expired.
1172 CPU time limit exceeded.
1174 File size limit exceeded.
1178 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1179 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1180 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1182 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1183 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1184 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1185 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1186 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1187 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1188 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1190 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1191 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1193 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1194 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1195 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1196 POSIX requires that these commands
1197 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1198 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1199 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1200 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1201 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1202 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1203 1000---not what you intended.
1205 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1206 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1207 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1208 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1209 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1213 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1217 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1218 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1219 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1221 @node Random sources
1222 @section Sources of random data
1224 @cindex random sources
1226 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1227 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1228 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1229 make this selection.
1231 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1232 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1233 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1234 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1236 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1237 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1238 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1239 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1240 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1241 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1242 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1243 and is relatively slow.
1245 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1246 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1247 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1248 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1251 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1252 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1253 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1255 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1256 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1263 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1264 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1267 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1270 @node Target directory
1271 @section Target directory
1273 @cindex target directory
1275 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1276 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1277 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1278 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1279 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1280 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1281 allow more fine-grained control:
1286 @itemx --no-target-directory
1287 @opindex --no-target-directory
1288 @cindex target directory
1289 @cindex destination directory
1290 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1291 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1292 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1293 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1294 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1295 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1296 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1297 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1298 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1300 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1301 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1302 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1304 @item -t @var{directory}
1305 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1306 @opindex --target-directory
1307 @cindex target directory
1308 @cindex destination directory
1309 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1312 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1313 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1314 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1315 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1316 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1318 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1319 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1320 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1321 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1322 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1323 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1324 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1325 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1328 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1329 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1330 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1331 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1334 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1337 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1338 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1339 files too, with this command:
1342 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1346 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1347 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1348 some other special characters.
1349 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1350 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1353 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1354 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1361 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1362 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1363 options cannot be combined.
1365 @node Trailing slashes
1366 @section Trailing slashes
1368 @cindex trailing slashes
1370 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1371 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1372 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1375 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1376 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1377 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1378 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1379 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1380 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1381 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1382 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1383 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1384 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1385 other parts of that standard.
1387 @node Traversing symlinks
1388 @section Traversing symlinks
1390 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1392 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1393 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1394 @c different meaning.
1395 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1396 option is also specified.
1397 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1399 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1400 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1401 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1403 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1404 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1405 a symlink or its referent.
1412 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1413 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1414 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1421 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1422 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1423 that is encountered.
1430 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1431 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1432 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1433 or @option{-P} is specified.
1440 @node Treating / specially
1441 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1443 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1444 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1445 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1446 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1447 legitimate uses for such a command,
1448 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1449 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1450 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1451 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1452 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1454 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1455 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1456 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1457 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1458 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1459 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1460 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1461 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1462 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1463 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1464 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1466 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1467 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1468 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1470 @node Special built-in utilities
1471 @section Special built-in utilities
1473 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1474 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1475 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1476 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1477 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1478 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1481 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1482 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1485 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1486 return set shift times trap unset}
1489 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1490 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1491 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1493 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1494 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1495 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1496 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1498 @node Standards conformance
1499 @section Standards conformance
1501 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1502 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1503 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1504 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1505 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1506 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1508 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1509 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1510 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1511 fields in each input line, but in POSIX 1003.1-2001
1512 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1513 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1514 sort. To complicate things further, POSIX 1003.1-2008 allows an
1515 implementation to have either the old or the new behavior.
1517 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1518 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1519 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1520 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1521 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1522 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1523 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1524 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1525 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1526 For example, if you have a POSIX 1003.1-2001 system but are running software
1527 containing traditional usage like @samp{sort +1} or @samp{tail +10},
1528 you can work around the compatibility problems by setting
1529 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=200809} in your environment.
1531 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1532 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1533 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1534 @node Multi-call invocation
1535 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1539 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1541 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1542 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1543 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1544 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1547 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1550 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1551 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1553 @node Output of entire files
1554 @chapter Output of entire files
1556 @cindex output of entire files
1557 @cindex entire files, output of
1559 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1563 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1564 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1565 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1566 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1567 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1568 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1571 @node cat invocation
1572 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1575 @cindex concatenate and write files
1576 @cindex copying files
1578 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1579 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1582 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1585 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1593 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1596 @itemx --number-nonblank
1598 @opindex --number-nonblank
1599 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1603 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1608 @opindex --show-ends
1609 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1615 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1616 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1619 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1621 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1622 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1623 @cindex squeezing blank lines
1624 Suppress repeated adjacent blank lines; output just one empty line
1629 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1634 @opindex --show-tabs
1635 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1639 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1642 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1644 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1645 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1646 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1651 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1652 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1653 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1654 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1655 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1656 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1657 if standard output is a terminal.
1664 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1667 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1672 @node tac invocation
1673 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1676 @cindex reversing files
1678 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1679 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1680 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1683 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1686 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1687 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1688 the record that it follows in the file.
1690 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1698 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1699 precedes in the file.
1705 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1707 @item -s @var{separator}
1708 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1710 @opindex --separator
1711 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1712 Note an empty @var{separator} is treated as a zero byte.
1713 I.e., input and output items are delimited with ASCII NUL.
1717 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1718 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1725 # Reverse a file character by character.
1731 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1734 @cindex numbering lines
1735 @cindex line numbering
1737 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1738 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1739 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1742 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1745 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1746 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) page sections;
1747 by default, the line number is reset to 1 at each logical page section.
1748 @command{nl} treats all of the input files as a single document;
1749 it does not reset line numbers or logical pages between files.
1751 @cindex headers, numbering
1752 @cindex body, numbering
1753 @cindex footers, numbering
1754 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1755 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1756 style from the others.
1758 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1759 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1770 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1771 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1772 length of each string cannot be changed.
1774 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1775 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1776 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1777 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1779 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1783 @item -b @var{style}
1784 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1786 @opindex --body-numbering
1787 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1788 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1789 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1790 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1796 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1798 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1800 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1801 expression @var{bre}.
1802 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1806 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1808 @opindex --section-delimiter
1809 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1810 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1811 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1812 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1813 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1815 @item -f @var{style}
1816 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1818 @opindex --footer-numbering
1819 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1821 @item -h @var{style}
1822 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1824 @opindex --header-numbering
1825 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1827 @item -i @var{number}
1828 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1830 @opindex --line-increment
1831 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1833 @item -l @var{number}
1834 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1836 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1837 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1838 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1839 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1840 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1841 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1842 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1845 @item -n @var{format}
1846 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1848 @opindex --number-format
1849 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1853 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1854 left justified, no leading zeros;
1856 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1857 right justified, no leading zeros;
1859 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1860 right justified, leading zeros.
1864 @itemx --no-renumber
1866 @opindex --no-renumber
1867 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1869 @item -s @var{string}
1870 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1872 @opindex --number-separator
1873 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1874 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1876 @item -v @var{number}
1877 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1879 @opindex --starting-line-number
1880 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1882 @item -w @var{number}
1883 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1885 @opindex --number-width
1886 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1894 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1897 @cindex octal dump of files
1898 @cindex hex dump of files
1899 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1900 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1902 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1903 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1907 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1908 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1909 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1910 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1913 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1914 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1915 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1916 printed as a single octal number.
1918 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1919 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1920 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1921 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1922 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1923 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1924 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1926 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1927 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1928 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1929 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1932 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1936 @item -A @var{radix}
1937 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1939 @opindex --address-radix
1940 @cindex radix for file offsets
1941 @cindex file offset radix
1942 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1943 be one of the following:
1953 none (do not print offsets).
1956 The default is octal.
1958 @item --endian=@var{order}
1960 @cindex byte-swapping
1962 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
1963 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
1964 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
1965 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
1966 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
1968 @item -j @var{bytes}
1969 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1971 @opindex --skip-bytes
1972 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1973 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1974 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1976 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
1978 @item -N @var{bytes}
1979 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1981 @opindex --read-bytes
1982 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1983 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1985 @item -S @var{bytes}
1986 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1989 @cindex string constants, outputting
1990 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1991 least @var{bytes} consecutive ASCII graphic characters,
1992 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
1993 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1996 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1999 @itemx --format=@var{type}
2002 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
2003 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
2004 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
2005 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
2006 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
2007 in the order that you specified.
2009 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
2010 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
2011 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2015 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2017 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2018 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2022 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2031 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2032 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2033 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2034 Type @code{c} outputs
2035 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2038 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2039 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2040 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2041 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2042 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2043 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2044 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2057 For floating point (@code{f}):
2069 @itemx --output-duplicates
2071 @opindex --output-duplicates
2072 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2073 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2074 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2075 indicate the elision.
2078 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2081 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2082 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2085 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2086 omitted, the default is 32.
2090 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2091 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2092 specification options. These options accumulate.
2098 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2102 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2106 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2107 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2111 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2115 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2119 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2123 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2127 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2131 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2135 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2138 @opindex --traditional
2139 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2140 accepted. The following syntax:
2143 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2147 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2148 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2149 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2150 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2151 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2159 @node base32 invocation
2160 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2163 @cindex base32 encoding
2165 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2166 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2167 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2168 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2169 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2172 @node base64 invocation
2173 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2176 @cindex base64 encoding
2178 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2179 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2180 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2184 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2185 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2188 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2189 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2190 The format conforms to
2191 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
2193 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2198 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2202 @cindex column to wrap data after
2203 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2206 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2207 disable line wrapping altogether.
2213 @cindex Decode base64 data
2214 @cindex Base64 decoding
2215 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2216 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2217 output will be the original data.
2220 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2222 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2223 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2224 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2225 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2226 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2233 @node Formatting file contents
2234 @chapter Formatting file contents
2236 @cindex formatting file contents
2238 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2241 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2242 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2243 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2247 @node fmt invocation
2248 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2251 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2252 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2253 @cindex text, reformatting
2255 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2256 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2259 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2262 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2263 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2265 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2266 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2267 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2270 @cindex line-breaking
2271 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2272 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2273 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2274 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2275 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2276 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2277 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2278 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2279 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2280 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2281 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2282 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2285 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2290 @itemx --crown-margin
2292 @opindex --crown-margin
2293 @cindex crown margin
2294 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2295 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2296 line with that of the second line.
2299 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2301 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2302 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2303 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2304 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2305 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2311 @opindex --split-only
2312 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2313 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2314 being unduly combined.
2317 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2319 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2320 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2321 between sentences to two spaces.
2324 @itemx -w @var{width}
2325 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2326 @opindex -@var{width}
2329 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2330 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2333 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2336 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2337 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2339 @item -p @var{prefix}
2340 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2341 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2342 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2343 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2344 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2345 leaving the code unchanged.
2352 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2355 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2356 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2357 @cindex merging files in parallel
2359 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2360 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2361 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2362 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2365 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2369 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2370 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2371 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2372 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2373 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2374 The text line of the header takes the form
2375 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2376 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2377 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2378 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2379 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2380 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2381 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2384 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2385 feeds produce empty pages.
2387 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2388 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2389 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2391 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2392 truncate lines in that case.
2394 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2398 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2399 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2400 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2401 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2402 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2403 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2404 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2405 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2406 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2407 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2408 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2409 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2410 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2411 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2412 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2416 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2417 @opindex -@var{column}
2419 @cindex down columns
2420 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2421 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2422 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2423 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2424 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2425 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2426 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2427 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2428 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2429 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2430 with @option{-m} option.
2436 @cindex across columns
2437 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2438 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2439 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2442 @itemx --show-control-chars
2444 @opindex --show-control-chars
2445 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2446 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2447 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2450 @itemx --double-space
2452 @opindex --double-space
2453 @cindex double spacing
2454 Double space the output.
2456 @item -D @var{format}
2457 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2458 @cindex time formats
2459 @cindex formatting times
2460 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2461 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2462 Except for directives, which start with
2463 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2464 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2465 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2467 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2469 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2470 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2471 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2472 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2473 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2474 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2477 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2478 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2479 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2480 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2482 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2483 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2485 @opindex --expand-tabs
2487 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2488 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2489 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2497 @opindex --form-feed
2498 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2499 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2501 @item -h @var{header}
2502 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2505 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2506 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2507 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2509 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2510 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2512 @opindex --output-tabs
2514 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2515 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2516 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2522 @opindex --join-lines
2523 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2524 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2525 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2526 no column alignment used; may be used with
2527 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2528 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2529 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2530 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2533 @item -l @var{page_length}
2534 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2537 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2538 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2539 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2540 @option{-t} option had been given.
2546 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2547 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2548 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2550 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2551 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2552 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2553 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2554 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2555 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2556 the middle blank part.
2558 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2559 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2561 @opindex --number-lines
2562 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2563 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2564 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2565 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2566 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2567 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2568 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2569 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2570 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2571 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2572 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2573 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2574 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2575 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2576 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2577 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2578 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2579 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2582 @item -N @var{line_number}
2583 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2585 @opindex --first-line-number
2586 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2587 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2589 @item -o @var{margin}
2590 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2593 @cindex indenting lines
2595 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2596 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2597 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2598 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2601 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2603 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2604 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2605 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2607 @item -s[@var{char}]
2608 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2610 @opindex --separator
2611 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2612 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2613 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2614 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2615 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2616 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2619 @item -S[@var{string}]
2620 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2622 @opindex --sep-string
2623 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2624 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2625 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2626 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2628 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2629 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2630 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2633 @itemx --omit-header
2635 @opindex --omit-header
2636 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2637 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2638 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2639 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2640 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2641 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2642 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2645 @itemx --omit-pagination
2647 @opindex --omit-pagination
2648 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2649 set in the input files.
2652 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2654 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2655 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2657 @item -w @var{page_width}
2658 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2661 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2662 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2663 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2664 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2665 and column alignment.
2666 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2667 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2668 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2670 @item -W @var{page_width}
2671 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2673 @opindex --page_width
2674 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2675 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2676 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2677 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2678 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2679 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2680 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2681 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2682 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2683 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2684 line is never truncated.
2691 @node fold invocation
2692 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2695 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2696 @cindex folding long input lines
2698 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2699 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2703 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2706 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2707 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2709 @cindex screen columns
2710 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2711 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2712 return sets the column to zero.
2714 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2722 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2723 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2730 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2731 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2732 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2734 @item -w @var{width}
2735 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2738 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2740 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2741 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2749 @node Output of parts of files
2750 @chapter Output of parts of files
2752 @cindex output of parts of files
2753 @cindex parts of files, output of
2755 These commands output pieces of the input.
2758 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2759 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2760 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2761 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2764 @node head invocation
2765 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2768 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2769 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2771 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2772 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2773 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2776 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2779 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2780 one-line header consisting of:
2783 ==> @var{file name} <==
2787 before the output for each @var{file}.
2789 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2793 @item -c [-]@var{num}
2794 @itemx --bytes=[-]@var{num}
2797 Print the first @var{num} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2798 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
2799 print all but the last @var{num} bytes of each file.
2800 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
2802 @item -n [-]@var{num}
2803 @itemx --lines=[-]@var{num}
2806 Output the first @var{num} lines.
2807 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
2808 print all but the last @var{num} lines of each file.
2809 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2817 Never print file name headers.
2823 Always print file name headers.
2829 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2830 @option{-[@var{num}][bkm][cqv]}, which is recognized only if it is
2831 specified first. @var{num} is a decimal number optionally followed
2832 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2833 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2834 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{num}}
2835 or @option{-n @var{num}} instead. If your script must also run on
2836 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2837 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2843 @node tail invocation
2844 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2847 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2849 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2850 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2851 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2854 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2857 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2858 one-line header before the output for each @var{file}, consisting of:
2861 ==> @var{file name} <==
2864 For further processing of tail output, it can be useful to convert the
2865 file headers to line prefixes, which can be done like:
2870 /^==> .* <==$/ @{prefix=substr($0,5,length-8)":"; next@}
2875 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2876 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2877 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2878 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2879 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2880 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2881 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2882 the GNU @command{tac} command.
2884 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2888 @item -c [+]@var{num}
2889 @itemx --bytes=[+]@var{num}
2892 Output the last @var{num} bytes, instead of final lines.
2893 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
2894 byte @var{num} from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2895 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
2898 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2901 @cindex growing files
2902 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2903 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2904 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2905 presumably because the file is growing.
2906 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2907 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2910 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2911 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2913 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2914 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2915 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2916 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2917 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
2918 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2919 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
2920 the need for any periodic reopening.
2922 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2923 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2924 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2926 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2927 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2928 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2929 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2930 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2931 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2932 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2933 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2936 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2937 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2939 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
2940 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2941 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
2942 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2944 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
2945 and is generally very prompt.
2946 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks---
2947 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default---which can
2948 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
2949 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
2950 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
2953 alias tail='tail -s.1'
2958 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2959 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2960 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2962 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2963 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2964 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2965 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2966 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2967 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2968 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2969 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2970 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2971 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2972 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
2973 and when following by name.
2975 @item -n [+]@var{num}
2976 @itemx --lines=[+]@var{}
2979 Output the last @var{num} lines.
2980 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
2981 line @var{num} from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2982 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2984 @item --pid=@var{pid}
2986 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2987 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2988 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2989 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2990 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2991 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2992 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2993 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2997 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
3000 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
3001 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
3002 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
3003 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
3004 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
3005 will print a warning if this is the case.
3013 Never print file name headers.
3017 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
3018 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
3020 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
3021 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
3022 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
3024 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
3025 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
3027 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
3028 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
3029 never checks it again.
3031 @item -s @var{number}
3032 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
3034 @opindex --sleep-interval
3035 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
3036 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
3038 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
3039 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
3040 an arbitrary floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
3041 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
3042 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
3043 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
3044 every @var{number} seconds.
3050 Always print file name headers.
3056 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3057 @samp{tail -[@var{num}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3058 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3059 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3060 file. In the option, @var{num} is an optional decimal number optionally
3061 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3062 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3063 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3065 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3066 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001, the leading @samp{-}
3067 can be replaced by @samp{+} in the traditional option syntax with the
3068 same meaning as in counts, and on obsolete systems predating POSIX
3069 1003.1-2001 traditional usage overrides normal usage when the two
3070 conflict. This behavior can be controlled with the
3071 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3074 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
3075 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{num}[b]}, @option{-n
3076 @var{num}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3077 run on hosts that support only the traditional syntax, you can often
3078 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3079 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3080 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3081 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3083 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3084 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3085 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3086 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3087 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3088 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3089 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3094 @node split invocation
3095 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3098 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3099 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3101 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3102 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3103 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3106 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3109 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3110 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3112 @cindex output file name prefix
3113 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3114 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3115 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3116 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3117 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3118 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3119 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3120 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3121 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3122 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3123 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3124 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3125 output files that it did create.
3127 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3131 @item -l @var{lines}
3132 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3135 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3136 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3137 the number of records.
3139 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3140 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3141 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3144 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3147 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3148 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3151 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3153 @opindex --line-bytes
3154 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3155 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3156 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3157 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3158 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3159 the number of records.
3161 @item --filter=@var{command}
3163 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3164 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3165 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3166 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3167 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3168 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on disk,
3169 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3170 of a more manageable size.
3171 To do that, you might run this command:
3174 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3177 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3178 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3180 @item -n @var{chunks}
3181 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3185 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3188 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3189 @var{k}/@var{n} only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3190 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3191 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3192 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3193 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3196 Any excess bytes remaining after dividing the @var{input}
3197 into @var{n} chunks, are assigned to the last chunk.
3198 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3199 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3201 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3202 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3204 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3205 The @var{input} is partitioned into @var{n} equal sized portions, with
3206 the last assigned any excess. If a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3207 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3208 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3209 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3210 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3212 For @samp{r} mode, the size of @var{input} is irrelevant,
3213 and so can be a pipe for example.
3215 @item -a @var{length}
3216 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3218 @opindex --suffix-length
3219 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3220 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3221 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3222 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3223 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3226 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3228 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3229 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3230 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3232 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3233 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3234 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3235 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3236 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. Note if option @option{--number} is specified and
3237 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3238 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3240 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3241 @opindex --additional-suffix
3242 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3243 must not contain slash.
3246 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3248 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3249 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3250 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3251 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3252 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3253 even when this option is specified.
3255 @item -t @var{separator}
3256 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3258 @opindex --separator
3259 @cindex line separator character
3260 @cindex record separator character
3261 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3262 newline character (ASCII LF).
3263 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3264 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3269 @opindex --unbuffered
3270 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3271 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3275 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3281 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3282 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3284 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3287 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3300 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3303 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3316 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3319 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3332 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3333 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3336 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3343 @node csplit invocation
3344 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3347 @cindex context splitting
3348 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3350 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3351 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3354 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3357 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3358 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3359 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3360 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3361 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3364 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3365 output file after it has been created.
3367 The types of pattern arguments are:
3372 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3373 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3374 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3375 file once for each repeat.
3377 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3378 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3379 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3380 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
3381 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3382 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3383 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3385 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3386 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3387 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3389 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3390 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3391 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3392 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3397 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3398 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3399 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3400 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3401 original input file.
3403 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3404 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3405 that it has created so far before it exits.
3407 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3411 @item -f @var{prefix}
3412 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3415 @cindex output file name prefix
3416 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3418 @item -b @var{format}
3419 @itemx --suffix-format=@var{format}
3421 @opindex --suffix-format
3422 @cindex output file name suffix
3423 Use @var{format} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3424 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3425 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3426 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3427 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3428 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3429 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3430 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3431 entire @var{format} is given (with the current output file number) to
3432 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3433 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3434 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3436 @item -n @var{digits}
3437 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3440 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3441 long instead of the default 2.
3446 @opindex --keep-files
3447 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3449 @item --suppress-matched
3450 @opindex --suppress-matched
3451 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3452 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3453 and subsequent splits.
3456 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3458 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3459 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3460 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3461 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3462 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3463 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3474 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3480 Here is an example of its usage.
3481 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3488 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3491 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3497 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3498 file that csplit has just created.
3499 List the names of those output files:
3506 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3531 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3534 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3538 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3539 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3541 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3544 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3546 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3547 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3550 @node Summarizing files
3551 @chapter Summarizing files
3553 @cindex summarizing files
3555 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3559 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3560 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3561 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3562 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
3563 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3564 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3565 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3570 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3574 @cindex character count
3578 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3579 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3580 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3583 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3586 @cindex total counts
3587 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3588 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3589 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3590 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3591 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3592 maximum line length.
3593 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3594 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3595 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3596 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3597 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3598 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3600 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3601 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3602 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3609 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3611 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3612 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3613 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3614 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3615 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3617 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3625 Print only the byte counts.
3631 Print only the character counts.
3637 Print only the word counts.
3643 Print only the newline counts.
3646 @itemx --max-line-length
3648 @opindex --max-line-length
3649 Print only the maximum display widths.
3650 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3651 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3652 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3654 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3655 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3656 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3657 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3658 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3659 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3660 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3661 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3663 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3664 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3666 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3667 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3668 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3669 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3671 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3672 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3673 file names are read from standard input.
3675 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3677 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3678 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3681 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3682 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3690 @node sum invocation
3691 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3694 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3695 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3697 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3698 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3701 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3704 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3705 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3706 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3707 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3708 at least one file argument.)
3710 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3711 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3714 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3720 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3721 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3722 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3723 given, it has no effect.
3729 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3730 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3731 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3735 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3736 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3741 @node cksum invocation
3742 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3745 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3746 @cindex CRC checksum
3748 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3749 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3750 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3753 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3756 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3757 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3759 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3760 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3761 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3762 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3765 The CRC algorithm is specified by the POSIX standard. It is not
3766 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3767 previous section); it is more robust.
3769 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3775 @node b2sum invocation
3776 @section @command{b2sum}: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
3780 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3781 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3782 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3783 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3785 @command{b2sum} computes a 512-bit checksum for each specified
3786 @var{file}. The same usage and options as the @command{md5sum}
3787 command are supported. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3788 In addition @command{b2sum} supports the following options.
3795 @cindex BLAKE2 hash length
3796 Change (shorten) the default digest length.
3797 This is specified in bits and thus must be a multiple of 8.
3798 This option is ignored when @option{--check} is specified,
3799 as the length is automatically determined when checking.
3802 @node md5sum invocation
3803 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3807 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3808 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3809 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3810 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3812 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3813 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3815 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3816 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3817 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3818 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
3819 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given MD5
3820 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
3821 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
3822 appear valid when signed with an MD5 digest. For more secure hashes,
3823 consider using SHA-2, or the newer @command{b2sum} command.
3824 @xref{sha2 utilities}. @xref{b2sum invocation}.
3826 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3827 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3828 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3829 consistent. Synopsis:
3832 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3835 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs by default, the MD5 checksum,
3836 a space, a flag indicating binary or text input mode, and the file name.
3837 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
3838 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
3839 otherwise text mode is the default.
3840 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3841 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3842 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3843 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3844 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3846 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3854 @cindex binary input files
3855 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3856 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3857 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
3858 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
3859 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3860 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3861 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3865 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3866 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3867 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3868 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3869 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3870 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
3871 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
3872 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
3873 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
3875 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3876 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3877 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3878 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3879 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3880 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3881 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3882 a warning is issued to standard error.
3883 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3884 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3885 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3886 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3887 it exits successfully.
3889 @item --ignore-missing
3890 @opindex --ignore-missing
3891 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3892 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3893 When verifying checksums, don't fail or report any status
3894 for missing files. This is useful when verifying a subset
3895 of downloaded files given a larger list of checksums.
3899 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3900 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3901 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3902 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3903 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3904 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3908 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3909 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3910 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3911 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3912 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3914 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3915 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3916 indicating there was a failure.
3921 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
3922 As a GNU extension, file names with problematic characters
3923 are escaped as described above, with the same escaping indicator of @samp{\}
3924 at the start of the line, being used.
3925 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
3926 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
3927 the output format, while providing little benefit.
3933 @cindex text input files
3934 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3935 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3936 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
3937 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3938 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3939 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
3945 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3946 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3947 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3952 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3953 When verifying checksums,
3954 if one or more input line is invalid,
3955 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
3962 @node sha1sum invocation
3963 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3967 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3968 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3969 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3970 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3972 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3973 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3974 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3976 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3977 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3978 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3979 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3980 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3981 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3984 @node sha2 utilities
3985 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3992 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3993 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3994 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3995 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3996 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3997 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3998 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3999 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4000 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
4001 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
4002 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
4003 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4004 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
4005 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
4006 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
4007 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4009 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
4010 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
4011 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
4012 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
4013 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}
4014 and @command{sha1sum}.
4015 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
4018 @node Operating on sorted files
4019 @chapter Operating on sorted files
4021 @cindex operating on sorted files
4022 @cindex sorted files, operations on
4024 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
4027 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
4028 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
4029 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
4030 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
4031 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
4032 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
4036 @node sort invocation
4037 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
4040 @cindex sorting files
4042 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
4043 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
4044 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
4048 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4051 @cindex sort stability
4052 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4053 Many options affect how @command{sort} compares lines; if the results
4054 are unexpected, try the @option{--debug} option to see what happened.
4055 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4056 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields (see @option{--key}), in the
4057 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4058 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4059 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4060 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4061 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4062 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4063 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4064 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4065 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4066 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4070 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4071 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4072 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4073 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4074 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4075 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4076 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4077 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4078 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4079 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4080 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4081 A line's trailing newline is not part of the line for comparison
4082 purposes. If the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4083 @command{sort} silently supplies one. GNU @command{sort} (as
4084 specified for all GNU utilities) has no limit on input line length or
4085 restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4087 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
4088 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
4095 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
4098 @cindex checking for sortedness
4099 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
4100 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
4101 exit with a status of 1.
4102 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4103 At most one input file can be given.
4106 @itemx --check=quiet
4107 @itemx --check=silent
4110 @cindex checking for sortedness
4111 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4112 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4113 At most one input file can be given.
4114 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4120 @cindex merging sorted files
4121 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4122 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4123 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4128 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4132 0 if no error occurred
4133 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4134 2 if an error occurred
4138 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4139 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4140 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4141 the environment variable.
4143 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4144 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4145 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4146 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4147 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4148 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4149 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4154 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4156 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4157 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4159 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4160 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4161 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4162 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4163 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4166 @itemx --dictionary-order
4168 @opindex --dictionary-order
4169 @cindex dictionary order
4170 @cindex phone directory order
4171 @cindex telephone directory order
4173 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4174 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4175 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4176 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4179 @itemx --ignore-case
4181 @opindex --ignore-case
4182 @cindex ignoring case
4183 @cindex case folding
4185 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4186 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4187 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4188 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4189 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4190 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4191 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4194 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4195 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4197 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4199 @cindex general numeric sort
4201 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4202 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4203 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4204 Use the following collating sequence:
4208 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4210 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4211 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4215 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4220 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4221 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4222 converting to floating point.
4225 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4226 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4228 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4230 @cindex human numeric sort
4232 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4233 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4234 one of @samp{MGTPEZY}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4235 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4236 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4237 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4238 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4239 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4240 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4241 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4242 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4243 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4244 Note also the @command{numfmt} command, which can be used to reformat
4245 numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort, thus often allowing
4246 sort to operate on more accurate numbers.
4249 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4251 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4252 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4253 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4255 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4256 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4257 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4258 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4264 @opindex --month-sort
4266 @cindex months, sorting by
4268 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4269 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4270 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4271 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4272 category determines the month spellings.
4273 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4277 @itemx --numeric-sort
4278 @itemx --sort=numeric
4280 @opindex --numeric-sort
4282 @cindex numeric sort
4284 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4285 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4286 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4287 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4288 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
4289 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
4290 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4293 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4295 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4296 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4297 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4300 @itemx --version-sort
4302 @opindex --version-sort
4303 @cindex version number sort
4304 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4305 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4306 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
4312 @cindex reverse sorting
4313 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4314 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4317 @itemx --random-sort
4318 @itemx --sort=random
4320 @opindex --random-sort
4323 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4324 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4325 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4326 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4327 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4329 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4330 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4331 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4334 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4335 @option{--random-source} option.
4343 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4344 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4346 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4347 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4348 standard input to standard output.
4350 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4352 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4353 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4355 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4357 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4358 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4362 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4363 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4364 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4366 In its simplest form @var{pos} specifies a field number (starting with 1),
4367 with fields being separated by runs of blank characters, and by default
4368 those blanks being included in the comparison at the start of each field.
4369 To adjust the handling of blank characters see the @option{-b} and
4370 @option{-t} options.
4373 each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4374 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4375 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4376 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4377 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4378 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4379 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4380 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4381 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4384 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4385 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4386 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4387 of the line being used in the sort.
4390 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4391 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to stderr.
4393 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4394 @opindex --batch-size
4395 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4396 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4398 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4399 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4400 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4402 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4403 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4404 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4405 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4408 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4409 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4412 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4413 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4414 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4415 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4416 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4417 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4418 silently uses a smaller value.
4420 @item -o @var{output-file}
4421 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4424 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4425 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4426 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4427 @var{output-file}, so you can sort a file in place by using
4428 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4429 However, it is often safer to output to an otherwise-unused file, as
4430 data may be lost if the system crashes or @command{sort} encounters
4431 an I/O or other serious error while a file is being sorted in place.
4432 Also, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4433 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4434 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4435 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4437 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4438 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4439 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4440 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4443 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4444 @opindex --random-source
4445 @cindex random source for sorting
4446 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4447 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4454 @cindex sort stability
4455 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4457 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4458 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4459 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4462 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4464 @opindex --buffer-size
4465 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4466 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4467 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4468 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4469 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4470 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4471 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}@. Appending
4472 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4475 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4476 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4477 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4478 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4481 @item -t @var{separator}
4482 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4484 @opindex --field-separator
4485 @cindex field separator character
4486 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4487 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4488 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4489 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4492 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4493 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4494 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4495 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4496 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4497 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4498 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4499 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4501 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4502 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4504 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4505 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4507 @opindex --temporary-directory
4508 @cindex temporary directory
4510 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4511 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4512 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4513 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4514 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4515 disks and controllers.
4517 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4519 @cindex multithreaded sort
4520 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4521 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4522 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4523 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4524 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4530 @cindex uniquifying output
4532 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4533 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4534 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4536 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4538 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4539 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4540 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4541 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4542 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4545 @macro newlineFieldSeparator
4546 Note with @option{-z} the newline character is treated as a field separator.
4551 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4552 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4553 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4554 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4555 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4556 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4557 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4558 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4559 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4561 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4562 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4563 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4564 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4565 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4566 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4567 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4568 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4569 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4570 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4572 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4573 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4574 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4575 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4577 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4578 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4579 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
4580 @command{sort} supports a traditional origin-zero
4581 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4582 The traditional command @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4583 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4584 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4585 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4587 This traditional behavior can be controlled with the
4588 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4589 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4590 not set by using the traditional syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
4592 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
4593 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
4594 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
4595 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
4596 support only the traditional syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
4597 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4600 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4605 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4612 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
4615 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
4619 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4620 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4621 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4622 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4623 and extending to the end of each line.
4630 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4631 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4632 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4635 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4638 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4639 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4640 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4641 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4642 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4644 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4645 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4646 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4647 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4648 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4649 field-end part of the key specifier.
4652 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4653 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4654 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4658 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4659 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4660 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4663 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4664 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4665 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4666 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4667 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4668 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4669 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4673 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4674 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4675 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4676 files contain lines that look like this:
4679 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4680 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4683 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4684 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4685 because 61 is less than 129.
4688 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4689 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4692 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4693 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4694 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4695 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4696 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4697 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4698 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4699 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4700 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4701 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4702 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4703 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4707 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4710 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4713 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4714 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4716 by the sort operation.
4718 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4720 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4721 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4722 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4725 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
4726 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
4728 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4732 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
4733 sort lines according to their length.
4736 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
4739 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
4740 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
4743 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4744 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4745 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4749 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4755 @node shuf invocation
4756 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4759 @cindex shuffling files
4761 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4762 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4766 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4767 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4768 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4771 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4772 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4773 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4781 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4782 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4784 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4785 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4787 @opindex --input-range
4788 @cindex input range to shuffle
4789 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4790 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4794 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4799 @item -n @var{count}
4800 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
4802 @opindex --head-count
4803 @cindex head of output
4804 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
4807 @item -o @var{output-file}
4808 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4811 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4812 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4813 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4814 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4815 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4817 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4818 @opindex --random-source
4819 @cindex random source for shuffling
4820 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4821 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4827 @cindex repeat output values
4828 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
4829 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
4830 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
4831 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
4832 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
4851 might produce the output
4861 Similarly, the command:
4864 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4878 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4888 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4889 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4890 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
4891 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4892 output permutations.
4895 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
4898 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
4902 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
4905 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
4911 @node uniq invocation
4912 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4915 @cindex uniquify files
4917 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4918 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4922 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4925 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4926 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4927 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4928 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4930 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4931 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4932 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4933 @xref{sort invocation}.
4936 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
4939 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4942 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4947 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4949 @opindex --skip-fields
4950 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4951 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4952 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4953 each other by at least one space or tab.
4955 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
4956 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4959 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4961 @opindex --skip-chars
4962 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4963 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4964 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4966 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4967 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
4968 @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
4970 Although this traditional behavior can be controlled with the
4971 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4972 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4973 behavior depends on this variable.
4974 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4975 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4981 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4984 @itemx --ignore-case
4986 @opindex --ignore-case
4987 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4993 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4994 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4995 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4999 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
5001 @opindex --all-repeated
5002 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
5003 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
5004 but discard lines that are not repeated.
5005 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
5006 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
5007 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
5008 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
5014 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
5015 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
5018 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
5019 @macro nulOutputNote
5020 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
5021 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
5026 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
5027 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
5028 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
5029 may be better suited for output direct to users.
5033 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
5034 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
5035 blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
5036 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to
5041 This is a GNU extension.
5042 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
5044 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
5046 @cindex all lines, grouping
5047 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
5049 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
5050 groups, and must be one of the following:
5055 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
5056 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
5057 and better suited for output direct to users.
5060 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
5063 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
5066 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
5071 This is a GNU extension.
5077 @cindex unique lines, outputting
5078 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
5079 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
5080 lines, and nothing else.
5083 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5085 @opindex --check-chars
5086 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5087 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5091 @newlineFieldSeparator
5098 @node comm invocation
5099 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5102 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5103 @cindex comparing sorted files
5105 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5106 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5107 standard input. Synopsis:
5110 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5114 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5115 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5116 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5117 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5118 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5120 @cindex differing lines
5121 @cindex common lines
5122 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5123 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5124 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5125 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5126 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5127 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5132 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5133 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5135 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5136 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5137 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5138 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5140 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5141 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5142 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5143 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5144 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5145 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5147 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5149 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5152 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5153 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5155 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5156 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5157 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5158 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5160 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5165 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5167 @item --nocheck-order
5168 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5172 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5173 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5174 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5176 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
5179 Output a summary at the end.
5181 Similar to the regular output,
5182 column one contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file1},
5183 column two contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file2}, and
5184 column three contains the total number of lines common to both files,
5185 followed by the word @samp{total} in the additional column four.
5187 In the following example, @command{comm} omits the regular output
5188 (@option{-123}), thus just printing the summary:
5191 $ printf '%s\n' a b c d e > file1
5192 $ printf '%s\n' b c d e f g > file2
5193 $ comm --total -123 file1 file2
5197 This option is a GNU extension. Portable scripts should use @command{wc} to
5198 get the totals, e.g. for the above example files:
5201 $ comm -23 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file1
5203 $ comm -13 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file2
5205 $ comm -12 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines common to both files
5213 @node ptx invocation
5214 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5218 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5219 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5222 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5223 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5226 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5227 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5228 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5229 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5230 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5231 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5233 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5235 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5236 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5237 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5238 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5239 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5240 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5241 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5242 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5245 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5246 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5247 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5248 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5249 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5250 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5251 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5252 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
5253 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5254 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5255 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5256 introduced by an option.
5258 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5259 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5260 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5261 convention more than once per program invocation.
5264 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5265 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5266 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5267 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5268 * Compatibility in ptx::
5272 @node General options in ptx
5273 @subsection General options
5278 @itemx --traditional
5279 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5280 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5283 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5287 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5295 @node Charset selection in ptx
5296 @subsection Charset selection
5298 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
5299 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
5300 using 8-bit ISO 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
5301 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
5302 character set of the IBM-PC@. (GNU @command{ptx} is not known to work on
5303 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit ASCII, the set
5304 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
5305 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
5306 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5307 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5313 @itemx --ignore-case
5315 @opindex --ignore-case
5316 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5321 @node Input processing in ptx
5322 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5327 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5329 @opindex --break-file
5331 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5332 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5333 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5334 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5335 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5336 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5337 @option{-b} is ignored.
5339 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5340 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5341 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5342 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5343 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5346 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5348 @opindex --ignore-file
5350 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5351 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5352 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5353 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5357 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5359 @opindex --only-file
5361 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5362 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5363 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5364 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5365 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5367 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5368 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5369 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5374 @opindex --references
5376 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5377 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5378 line in the resulting permuted index.
5379 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5380 for more information about reference production.
5381 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5383 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5384 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5385 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5386 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5387 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5388 excluded from the output contexts.
5390 @item -S @var{regexp}
5391 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5393 @opindex --sentence-regexp
5395 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5396 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5397 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5398 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5399 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5400 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5401 imported from GNU Emacs:
5404 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5407 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5408 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5414 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5415 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5416 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5417 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5418 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5421 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5422 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5423 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5424 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5425 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5426 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5427 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5428 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5429 on the right of the output line.
5431 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5432 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5433 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5435 @item -W @var{regexp}
5436 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5438 @opindex --word-regexp
5440 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5441 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5442 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5443 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5444 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5446 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5447 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5450 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5451 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5452 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5457 @node Output formatting in ptx
5458 @subsection Output formatting
5460 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5461 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5462 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5463 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5464 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5465 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5466 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5467 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5468 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5469 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5470 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5471 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5472 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5473 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5474 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5475 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5477 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5481 @item -g @var{number}
5482 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5486 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5489 @item -w @var{number}
5490 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5494 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5495 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5496 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5497 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5498 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5499 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5500 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5501 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5505 @itemx --auto-reference
5507 @opindex --auto-reference
5509 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5510 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5511 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5512 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5513 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5514 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5517 @itemx --right-side-refs
5519 @opindex --right-side-refs
5521 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5522 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5523 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5524 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5525 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5526 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5527 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5528 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5530 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5533 @item -F @var{string}
5534 @itemx --flag-truncation=@var{string}
5536 @opindex --flag-truncation
5538 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5539 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5540 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5541 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5542 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5543 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5544 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5545 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5546 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5548 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5549 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5550 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5553 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5554 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5555 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5557 @item -M @var{string}
5558 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5560 @opindex --macro-name
5562 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5563 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5566 @itemx --format=roff
5568 @opindex --format=roff
5570 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5571 processing. Each output line will look like:
5574 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5575 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5578 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5579 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5580 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5581 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5583 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5584 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5585 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
5586 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5591 @opindex --format=tex
5593 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5594 line will look like:
5597 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
5598 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5602 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5603 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5604 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5605 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5606 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5609 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
5610 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
5611 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
5612 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5613 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5614 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5615 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5616 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5617 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5618 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
5619 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5620 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5621 processing for @TeX{}.
5626 @node Compatibility in ptx
5627 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
5629 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5630 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5631 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5632 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5633 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
5634 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5639 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5640 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5641 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5642 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5645 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5646 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5647 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
5648 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5649 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5650 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5651 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5654 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5655 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5656 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
5657 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5658 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5661 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5662 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5663 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5666 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5667 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
5668 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5669 line width computations.
5672 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
5673 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
5674 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
5675 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
5676 @samp{~} is also rejected.
5679 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
5680 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5681 the first 200 characters in each line.
5684 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5685 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
5686 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5690 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
5691 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5692 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5693 not completely reproduce.
5696 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5697 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5702 @node tsort invocation
5703 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
5706 @cindex topological sort
5708 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
5709 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
5710 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
5714 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
5717 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
5718 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
5719 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
5733 will produce the output
5744 Consider a more realistic example.
5745 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
5746 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
5747 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
5748 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
5749 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
5750 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
5751 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
5752 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
5753 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
5754 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
5755 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
5756 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
5762 tail_file pretty_name
5763 tail_file write_header
5765 tail_forever recheck
5766 tail_forever pretty_name
5767 tail_forever write_header
5768 tail_forever dump_remainder
5771 tail_lines start_lines
5772 tail_lines dump_remainder
5773 tail_lines file_lines
5774 tail_lines pipe_lines
5776 tail_bytes start_bytes
5777 tail_bytes dump_remainder
5778 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
5779 file_lines dump_remainder
5783 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
5784 functions that satisfies your requirement.
5787 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
5807 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
5808 encountered to standard error.
5810 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
5811 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
5812 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
5813 precedes @code{main}.
5815 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
5821 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
5824 @node tsort background
5825 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
5827 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
5828 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
5829 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
5830 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
5833 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
5834 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
5835 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
5836 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
5837 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
5838 reference to @code{read}.
5840 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
5841 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
5842 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
5843 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
5846 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
5847 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
5849 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
5850 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
5851 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
5852 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
5855 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
5856 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
5860 @node Operating on fields
5861 @chapter Operating on fields
5864 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5865 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5866 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5870 @node cut invocation
5871 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5874 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5875 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5879 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5882 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5883 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5884 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5885 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5886 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5887 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5888 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5889 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5890 is written exactly once.
5892 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5897 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5898 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5901 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5902 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5903 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5904 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5905 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5907 @item -c @var{character-list}
5908 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5910 @opindex --characters
5911 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5912 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5913 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5914 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5915 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5916 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5919 @item -f @var{field-list}
5920 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5923 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5924 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5925 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5926 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
5928 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
5929 like reordering fields, and handling fields aligned with blank characters.
5930 By default @command{awk} uses (and discards) runs of blank characters
5931 to separate fields, and ignores leading and trailing blanks.
5934 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
5935 awk '{print $NF-1}' # print the penultimate field
5936 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
5939 Note while @command{cut} accepts field specifications in
5940 arbitrary order, output is always in the order encountered in the file.
5942 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
5943 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
5944 characters as @command{awk} does above.
5947 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
5948 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
5952 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5953 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5955 @opindex --delimiter
5956 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5957 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5961 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5964 @itemx --only-delimited
5966 @opindex --only-delimited
5967 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5968 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5970 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5971 @opindex --output-delimiter
5972 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5973 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5974 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5975 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5976 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5977 ranges of selected bytes.
5980 @opindex --complement
5981 This option is a GNU extension.
5982 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5983 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5984 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5985 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5986 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5995 @node paste invocation
5996 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5999 @cindex merging files
6001 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
6002 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
6003 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
6009 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6023 Take lines sequentially from each file:
6031 Duplicate lines from a file:
6033 $ paste num2 let3 num2
6039 Intermix lines from stdin:
6041 $ paste - let3 - < num2
6047 Join consecutive lines with a space:
6049 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
6054 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6062 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
6063 file. Using the above example data:
6066 $ paste -s num2 let3
6071 @item -d @var{delim-list}
6072 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
6074 @opindex --delimiters
6075 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
6076 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
6077 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
6080 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
6093 @node join invocation
6094 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
6097 @cindex common field, joining on
6099 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
6100 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
6103 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
6106 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
6107 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
6108 sorted on the join fields.
6111 Normally, the sort order is that of the
6112 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
6113 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
6114 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
6115 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
6116 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
6118 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
6119 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
6120 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
6121 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
6122 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
6123 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
6124 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
6125 matches the default operation of sort.
6127 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
6128 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
6129 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
6130 considers them to be equal. For example:
6148 @checkOrderOption{join}
6153 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6154 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6155 blanks on the line ignored;
6156 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6157 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6158 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6161 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6165 @item -a @var{file-number}
6167 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6168 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6171 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6173 @item --nocheck-order
6174 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6176 @item -e @var{string}
6178 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6179 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6183 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6184 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6185 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6186 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6187 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6188 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6191 @itemx --ignore-case
6193 @opindex --ignore-case
6194 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6195 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6196 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6198 @item -1 @var{field}
6200 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6202 @item -2 @var{field}
6204 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6206 @item -j @var{field}
6207 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6209 @item -o @var{field-list}
6211 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6212 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6213 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6214 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6217 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6218 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6219 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6220 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6222 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6223 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6224 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6225 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6226 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6227 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6228 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6229 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6230 field specification notation.
6232 The elements in @var{field-list}
6233 are separated by commas or blanks.
6234 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6235 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6236 2.2'} are equivalent.
6238 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
6239 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6242 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6243 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6244 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6245 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6246 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6247 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6248 character is used to delimit the fields.
6250 @item -v @var{file-number}
6251 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6252 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6255 @newlineFieldSeparator
6262 @node Operating on characters
6263 @chapter Operating on characters
6265 @cindex operating on characters
6267 These commands operate on individual characters.
6270 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
6271 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
6272 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
6277 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
6284 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
6287 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
6288 one of the following operations:
6292 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
6294 squeeze repeated characters,
6298 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
6301 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
6302 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
6303 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
6304 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
6306 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
6308 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
6309 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
6310 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
6311 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
6312 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
6313 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
6314 the input contains encoding errors.
6316 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
6317 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
6322 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
6323 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
6324 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters.
6328 @node Character sets
6329 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
6331 @cindex specifying sets of characters
6333 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
6334 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
6335 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
6336 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
6337 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
6338 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
6342 @item Backslash escapes
6343 @cindex backslash escapes
6345 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
6363 The 8-bit character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
6364 octal digits. Note that @samp{\400} is interpreted as the two-byte
6365 sequence, @samp{\040} @samp{0}.
6370 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
6371 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
6372 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
6373 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
6378 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
6379 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
6380 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
6381 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
6383 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
6384 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
6385 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
6386 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
6387 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
6390 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
6391 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
6392 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
6393 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
6394 If you can rely on a POSIX compliant version of @command{tr}, then
6395 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
6396 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
6399 @item Repeated characters
6400 @cindex repeated characters
6402 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
6403 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
6404 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
6405 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
6406 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
6407 octal, otherwise in decimal.
6409 @item Character classes
6410 @cindex character classes
6412 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
6413 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
6414 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
6415 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
6416 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
6417 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
6418 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
6419 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
6420 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
6421 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
6422 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
6434 Horizontal whitespace.
6443 Printable characters, not including space.
6449 Printable characters, including space.
6452 Punctuation characters.
6455 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
6464 @item Equivalence classes
6465 @cindex equivalence classes
6467 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
6468 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
6469 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
6470 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
6471 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
6472 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
6473 which is of no particular use.
6479 @subsection Translating
6481 @cindex translating characters
6483 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
6484 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
6485 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
6486 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
6487 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
6488 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
6489 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
6490 two commands are equivalent:
6497 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
6498 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
6501 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
6503 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
6507 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
6509 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
6510 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
6511 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
6513 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
6514 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
6515 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
6516 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
6517 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
6519 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
6520 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
6521 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
6522 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
6524 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
6528 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
6532 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
6533 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
6537 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
6538 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
6539 Assuming a POSIX compliant @command{tr}, here is a better
6543 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6547 @node Squeezing and deleting
6548 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
6550 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
6551 @cindex deleting characters
6552 @cindex removing characters
6554 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
6555 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
6557 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option
6558 and not translating, @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a
6559 repeated character that is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of
6562 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
6563 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
6564 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6566 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
6567 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
6568 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6570 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
6575 Remove all zero bytes:
6582 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
6583 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
6584 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
6587 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6591 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline.
6592 I.e., delete blank lines:
6599 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
6600 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
6601 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
6602 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
6603 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
6604 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
6605 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
6606 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
6612 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
6613 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
6618 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
6619 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
6625 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
6626 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
6627 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
6628 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
6629 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
6630 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
6631 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
6632 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
6633 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
6640 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
6646 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
6647 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
6653 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
6654 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
6659 @node expand invocation
6660 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
6663 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
6664 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
6666 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
6667 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
6668 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
6672 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6675 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
6676 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
6677 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
6678 tabs every 8 columns).
6680 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6684 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6685 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6688 @cindex tab stops, setting
6689 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
6690 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
6691 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
6692 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
6693 blanks as well as by commas.
6695 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
6696 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
6697 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
6703 @cindex initial tabs, converting
6704 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
6705 characters) on each line to spaces.
6712 @node unexpand invocation
6713 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
6717 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
6718 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
6719 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
6720 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
6721 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
6722 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
6725 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6728 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
6729 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
6730 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
6731 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
6734 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6738 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6739 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6742 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
6743 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
6744 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
6745 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
6746 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
6748 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
6749 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
6750 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
6751 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
6752 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
6758 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
6759 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
6766 @node Directory listing
6767 @chapter Directory listing
6769 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
6770 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
6773 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
6774 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
6775 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
6776 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
6781 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
6784 @cindex directory listing
6786 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
6787 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
6788 arbitrarily, as usual.
6790 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
6791 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
6792 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
6793 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
6794 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
6795 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
6798 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
6799 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
6800 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
6801 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
6802 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
6803 If standard output is
6804 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
6805 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
6806 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
6808 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
6809 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
6810 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
6811 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
6812 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
6814 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
6819 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
6820 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
6821 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
6822 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
6823 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
6824 or a directory loop)
6827 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6830 * Which files are listed::
6831 * What information is listed::
6832 * Sorting the output::
6833 * Details about version sort::
6834 * General output formatting::
6835 * Formatting file timestamps::
6836 * Formatting the file names::
6840 @node Which files are listed
6841 @subsection Which files are listed
6843 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6844 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6845 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6846 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6854 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6859 @opindex --almost-all
6860 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6861 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6862 option overrides this option.
6865 @itemx --ignore-backups
6867 @opindex --ignore-backups
6868 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6869 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6870 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6875 @opindex --directory
6876 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6877 than listing their contents.
6878 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6879 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6880 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6881 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6882 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6885 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6887 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6888 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6889 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6890 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6892 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6893 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6894 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6895 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6896 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6897 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6899 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6900 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6901 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6903 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6904 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6906 @item --group-directories-first
6907 @opindex --group-directories-first
6908 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6909 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6910 (see --sort option).
6911 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6912 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6913 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6914 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6916 @item --hide=PATTERN
6917 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6918 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6919 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6920 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6921 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6922 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6923 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6925 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6926 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6927 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6928 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6930 @item -I @var{pattern}
6931 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6933 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6934 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6935 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6936 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6937 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6938 to give this option several times. For example,
6941 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6944 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6945 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6946 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6949 @itemx --dereference
6951 @opindex --dereference
6952 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6953 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6954 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6955 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6956 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6961 @opindex --recursive
6962 @cindex recursive directory listing
6963 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6964 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6969 @node What information is listed
6970 @subsection What information is listed
6972 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6973 default, only file names are shown.
6979 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6980 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6981 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6982 operating systems the two are the same.
6988 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6989 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6993 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6997 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
6998 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6999 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
7000 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
7002 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
7003 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
7006 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
7009 Finally, output a line of the form:
7012 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
7016 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
7018 Here is an actual example:
7021 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
7023 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
7024 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
7027 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
7028 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
7029 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
7030 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
7034 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
7038 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
7042 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
7043 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
7044 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
7047 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
7048 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
7050 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
7051 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
7053 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
7054 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
7057 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
7058 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
7062 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
7063 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
7064 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
7065 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
7066 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
7071 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
7072 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
7074 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
7077 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
7078 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
7079 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
7080 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
7081 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
7082 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
7083 prepared to parse the escaped names.
7086 @opindex --full-time
7087 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
7088 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
7089 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
7093 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
7099 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
7100 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
7101 provide this option for compatibility.)
7109 @cindex inode number, printing
7110 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
7111 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
7112 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
7115 @itemx --format=long
7116 @itemx --format=verbose
7119 @opindex long ls @r{format}
7120 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
7121 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
7122 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
7123 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
7124 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
7125 cannot be determined.
7127 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
7128 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
7129 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
7130 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
7131 separator of the current locale.
7133 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
7134 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
7135 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
7136 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7137 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
7138 this is arguably a deficiency.
7140 The file type is one of the following characters:
7142 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
7150 character special file
7152 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
7156 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
7158 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
7162 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
7164 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
7166 network special file (HP-UX)
7170 port (Solaris 10 and up)
7172 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
7176 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7178 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7180 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
7182 some other file type
7185 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
7186 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
7187 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
7188 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
7192 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
7196 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
7197 executable bit is not set.
7200 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
7201 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
7202 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
7205 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
7206 other-executable bit is not set.
7209 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
7215 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
7216 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
7217 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
7218 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
7219 character, then there is such a method.
7221 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
7222 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
7224 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
7225 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
7228 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
7230 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
7231 @cindex numeric uid and gid
7232 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
7233 Produce long format directory listings, but
7234 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
7238 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
7239 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
7245 @cindex disk allocation
7246 @cindex size of files, reporting
7247 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
7248 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
7249 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
7251 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
7252 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7254 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
7255 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
7256 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
7257 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
7258 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
7259 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
7268 @cindex security context
7269 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
7270 When used with the @option{-l} option, print the security context
7271 to the left of the size column.
7276 @node Sorting the output
7277 @subsection Sorting the output
7279 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
7280 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
7281 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
7282 (e.g., ASCII order).
7288 @itemx --time=status
7291 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
7292 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
7293 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7294 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
7295 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
7296 the modification time.
7297 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7298 or when not using a long listing format,
7299 sort according to the status change time.
7303 @cindex unsorted directory listing
7304 @cindex directory order, listing by
7305 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
7306 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
7307 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
7308 were specified before the @option{-f}).
7314 @cindex reverse sorting
7315 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
7316 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
7322 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
7323 Sort by file size, largest first.
7329 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
7330 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
7334 @itemx --time=access
7338 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7339 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7340 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7341 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
7342 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
7343 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7344 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
7350 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7351 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
7352 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
7353 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
7354 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
7357 @itemx --sort=version
7360 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7361 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
7362 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
7363 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
7366 @itemx --sort=extension
7369 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
7370 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
7371 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
7376 @node Details about version sort
7377 @subsection Details about version sort
7379 Version sorting handles the fact that file names frequently include indices or
7380 version numbers. Standard sorting usually does not produce the order that one
7381 expects because comparisons are made on a character-by-character basis.
7382 Version sorting is especially useful when browsing directories that contain
7383 many files with indices/version numbers in their names:
7387 abc.zml-1.gz abc.zml-1.gz
7388 abc.zml-12.gz abc.zml-2.gz
7389 abc.zml-2.gz abc.zml-12.gz
7392 Version-sorted strings are compared such that if @var{ver1} and @var{ver2}
7393 are version numbers and @var{prefix} and @var{suffix} (@var{suffix} matching
7394 the regular expression @samp{(\.[A-Za-z~][A-Za-z0-9~]*)*}) are strings then
7395 @var{ver1} < @var{ver2} implies that the name composed of
7396 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver1} @var{suffix}'' sorts before
7397 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver2} @var{suffix}''.
7399 Note also that leading zeros of numeric parts are ignored:
7403 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
7404 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
7405 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
7408 This functionality is implemented using gnulib's @code{filevercmp} function,
7409 which has some caveats worth noting.
7412 @item @env{LC_COLLATE} is ignored, which means @samp{ls -v} and @samp{sort -V}
7413 will sort non-numeric prefixes as if the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category
7414 was set to @samp{C}@.
7415 @item Some suffixes will not be matched by the regular
7416 expression mentioned above. Consequently these examples may
7417 not sort as you expect:
7425 abc-1.2.3.4.x86_64.rpm
7426 abc-1.2.3.x86_64.rpm
7430 @node General output formatting
7431 @subsection General output formatting
7433 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
7438 @itemx --format=single-column
7441 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
7442 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
7443 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{-b} and @option{-q} options
7444 to suppress direct output of newline characters within a file name.
7447 @itemx --format=vertical
7450 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
7451 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
7452 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
7453 for the @command{dir} program.
7454 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
7455 possible in the fewest lines.
7457 @item --color [=@var{when}]
7459 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
7460 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
7461 may be omitted, or one of:
7464 @vindex none @r{color option}
7465 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
7467 @vindex auto @r{color option}
7468 @cindex terminal, using color iff
7469 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
7471 @vindex always @r{color option}
7474 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7475 @option{--color=always}.
7476 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
7477 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
7478 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
7481 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7482 Note that using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
7483 performance penalty when run in a directory with very many entries,
7484 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
7485 single file it lists.
7486 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
7487 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
7488 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
7489 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
7491 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
7492 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
7494 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
7495 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
7499 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
7502 @opindex --indicator-style
7503 @cindex file type and executables, marking
7504 @cindex executables and file type, marking
7505 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
7506 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
7507 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
7508 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
7509 and nothing for regular files.
7510 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
7511 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7512 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7513 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7514 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7517 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
7518 @opindex --file-type
7519 @opindex --indicator-style
7520 @cindex file type, marking
7521 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
7522 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
7524 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
7525 @opindex --indicator-style
7526 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
7531 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
7533 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
7536 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
7537 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
7538 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
7540 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
7541 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
7542 @option{--classify} option.
7548 @opindex --kibibytes
7549 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
7550 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
7551 (@pxref{Block size}). This option is in turn overridden by the
7552 @option{--block-size}, @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable}, and
7553 @option{--si} options.
7555 The @option{-k} or @option{--kibibytes} option affects the
7556 per-directory block count written by the @option{-l} and similar
7557 options, and the size written by the @option{-s} or @option{--size}
7558 option. It does not affect the file size written by @option{-l}.
7561 @itemx --format=commas
7564 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
7565 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
7566 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
7569 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
7571 @opindex --indicator-style
7572 @cindex file type, marking
7573 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
7576 @itemx --format=across
7577 @itemx --format=horizontal
7580 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
7581 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
7582 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
7585 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
7588 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
7589 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
7590 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
7592 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
7593 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
7594 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
7595 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
7598 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
7602 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
7603 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
7604 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
7605 is 80. With a @var{cols} value of @samp{0}, there is no limit on
7606 the length of the output line, and that single output line will
7607 be delimited with spaces, not tabs.
7612 @node Formatting file timestamps
7613 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
7615 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
7616 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} for non-recent timestamps, and a
7617 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
7618 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
7621 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
7622 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
7623 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
7624 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
7625 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
7628 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
7629 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
7630 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
7631 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
7633 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
7636 @item --time-style=@var{style}
7637 @opindex --time-style
7639 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
7640 be one of the following:
7645 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
7646 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
7647 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
7648 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
7649 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
7650 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
7652 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
7653 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
7654 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
7655 spaces in one of the two formats.
7658 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
7659 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
7660 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
7661 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
7663 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
7664 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
7665 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
7666 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
7669 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
7670 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
7671 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
7672 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
7675 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
7676 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601-like month, day, hour, and
7677 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
7678 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
7679 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
7680 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
7681 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7686 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
7687 ls -l --time-style="iso"
7692 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
7693 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
7694 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
7695 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
7696 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
7697 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
7699 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
7700 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
7701 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
7702 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7707 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
7708 ls -l --time-style="locale"
7711 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
7712 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
7713 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
7714 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
7715 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
7717 @item posix-@var{style}
7719 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
7720 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
7721 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
7722 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
7723 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
7728 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
7729 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
7730 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
7731 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
7732 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
7733 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
7734 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
7736 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
7737 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
7740 @node Formatting the file names
7741 @subsection Formatting the file names
7743 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
7749 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
7752 @opindex --quoting-style
7753 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
7754 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
7755 backslash sequences like those used in C.
7759 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
7762 @opindex --quoting-style
7763 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
7764 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
7765 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
7769 @itemx --hide-control-chars
7771 @opindex --hide-control-chars
7772 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
7773 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
7778 @itemx --quoting-style=c
7780 @opindex --quote-name
7781 @opindex --quoting-style
7782 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
7785 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
7786 @opindex --quoting-style
7787 @cindex quoting style
7788 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
7789 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
7790 be one of the following:
7792 @macro quotingStyles
7795 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
7796 @option{--literal} option.
7798 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
7799 cause ambiguous output.
7800 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
7801 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
7804 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
7806 Like @samp{shell}, but also quoting non-printable characters using the POSIX
7807 proposed @samp{$''} syntax suitable for most shells.
7808 @item shell-escape-always
7809 Like @samp{shell-escape}, but quote strings even if they would
7810 normally not require quoting.
7812 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
7813 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
7814 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
7816 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
7817 surrounding double-quote
7818 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
7820 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7821 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
7824 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
7825 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7826 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
7827 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
7828 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
7833 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
7834 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
7835 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{shell-escape} when the
7836 output is a terminal, and @samp{literal} otherwise.
7838 @item --show-control-chars
7839 @opindex --show-control-chars
7840 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
7841 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
7847 @node dir invocation
7848 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
7851 @cindex directory listing, brief
7853 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
7854 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
7855 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7857 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7860 @node vdir invocation
7861 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
7864 @cindex directory listing, verbose
7866 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
7867 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
7868 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7870 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7872 @node dircolors invocation
7873 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
7877 @cindex setup for color
7879 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
7880 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
7884 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
7887 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
7888 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
7889 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
7890 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
7892 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
7893 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
7894 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7898 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7902 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7903 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7904 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7905 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7906 environment variable.
7908 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7913 @itemx --bourne-shell
7916 @opindex --bourne-shell
7917 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7918 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7919 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7920 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7929 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7930 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7931 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7932 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7935 @itemx --print-database
7937 @opindex --print-database
7938 @cindex color database, printing
7939 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7940 @cindex printing color database
7941 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7942 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7943 of the possibilities.
7950 @node Basic operations
7951 @chapter Basic operations
7953 @cindex manipulating files
7955 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7956 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7959 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7960 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7961 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7962 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7963 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7964 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7969 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7972 @cindex copying files and directories
7973 @cindex files, copying
7974 @cindex directories, copying
7976 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7977 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7978 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7982 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7983 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7984 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7989 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7993 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7994 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7995 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7996 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7997 using the @var{source}s' names.
8000 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
8001 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
8003 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
8004 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
8005 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
8006 to corresponding destination directories.
8008 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
8009 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
8010 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
8011 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
8012 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
8013 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
8014 the last one silently overrides the others.
8016 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
8017 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
8018 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
8019 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
8020 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
8021 practice and to POSIX@.
8022 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
8023 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
8024 Also, when an option like
8025 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
8026 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
8027 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
8029 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
8030 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
8031 @option{--copy-contents} option.
8033 @cindex self-backups
8034 @cindex backups, making only
8035 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
8036 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
8037 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
8038 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
8039 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
8040 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
8042 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8049 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
8050 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
8051 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
8052 directory in a different order).
8053 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
8054 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
8055 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
8057 @item --attributes-only
8058 @opindex --attributes-only
8059 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
8060 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
8061 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
8064 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
8067 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
8068 @cindex backups, making
8069 @xref{Backup options}.
8070 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
8071 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
8072 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
8073 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
8074 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
8078 # Usage: backup FILE...
8079 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
8082 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
8087 @item --copy-contents
8088 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8089 @cindex copying directories recursively
8090 @cindex recursively copying directories
8091 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8092 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
8093 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
8094 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
8095 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
8096 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
8097 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
8098 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
8099 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
8100 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
8101 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
8102 affect the copying of symbolic links.
8106 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8107 @cindex hard links, preserving
8108 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8109 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
8110 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
8116 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
8117 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
8118 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
8119 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
8120 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
8121 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
8122 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
8124 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
8125 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
8127 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
8132 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
8133 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
8134 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
8135 via recursive traversal.
8138 @itemx --interactive
8140 @opindex --interactive
8141 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
8142 overwrite an existing destination file. The @option{-i} option overrides
8143 a previous @option{-n} option.
8149 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
8152 @itemx --dereference
8154 @opindex --dereference
8155 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
8156 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
8157 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
8158 a regular file in the destination tree.
8163 @opindex --no-clobber
8164 Do not overwrite an existing file. The @option{-n} option overrides a previous
8165 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
8166 @option{--backup} option.
8169 @itemx --no-dereference
8171 @opindex --no-dereference
8172 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8173 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8174 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
8175 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
8178 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
8181 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
8182 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
8183 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
8184 of one or more of the following strings:
8188 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
8190 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
8191 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
8193 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
8194 a member of the desired group.
8196 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
8197 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
8198 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
8199 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
8200 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
8202 Preserve in the destination files
8203 any links between corresponding source files.
8204 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
8205 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
8207 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
8212 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
8213 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
8214 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
8215 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
8216 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
8217 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
8218 will preserve the perceived hard link.
8220 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
8222 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
8228 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8230 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8231 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
8232 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
8233 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
8234 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
8236 Preserve all file attributes.
8237 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
8238 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
8239 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
8240 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
8243 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
8244 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
8246 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
8247 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
8248 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
8249 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
8250 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
8252 @xref{File permissions}.
8254 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
8255 @cindex file information, preserving
8256 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
8257 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
8261 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
8262 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
8263 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
8264 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
8265 For example, the command:
8268 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
8272 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
8273 any missing intermediate directories.
8280 @opindex --recursive
8281 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8282 @cindex copying directories recursively
8283 @cindex recursively copying directories
8284 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8285 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
8286 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
8287 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
8288 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
8289 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
8290 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
8291 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
8292 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
8293 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
8294 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
8295 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
8296 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
8297 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
8299 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
8300 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
8303 @cindex copy on write
8304 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
8305 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
8306 files share the same disk data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
8307 Thus, if a disk I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
8308 the other suffers the same fate.
8310 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8314 The default behavior: if the copy-on-write operation is not supported
8315 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
8318 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
8319 to the standard copy behavior.
8322 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
8323 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
8324 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
8325 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
8326 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
8329 alias cp='cp --reflink=auto --sparse=always'
8332 @item --remove-destination
8333 @opindex --remove-destination
8334 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
8335 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
8337 @item --sparse=@var{when}
8338 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
8339 @cindex sparse files, copying
8340 @cindex holes, copying files with
8341 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
8342 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
8343 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
8344 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
8345 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
8346 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
8347 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
8348 Only regular files may be sparse.
8350 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8354 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
8355 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
8356 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
8359 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
8360 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
8361 input file does not appear to be sparse.
8362 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
8363 that does not support sparse files
8364 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
8365 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
8366 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
8367 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
8370 Never make the output file sparse.
8371 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
8372 since such a file must not have any holes.
8375 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8378 @itemx --symbolic-link
8380 @opindex --symbolic-link
8381 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
8382 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
8383 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
8384 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
8385 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8391 @optNoTargetDirectory
8397 @cindex newer files, copying only
8398 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8399 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
8400 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
8401 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
8402 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
8403 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
8404 If @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
8405 for example), that will take precedence. Consequently, depending on the
8406 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
8407 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
8413 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8416 @itemx --one-file-system
8418 @opindex --one-file-system
8419 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
8420 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
8421 the copy started on.
8422 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
8426 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
8429 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
8430 @cindex security context
8431 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
8432 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
8433 @command{restorecon} command.
8434 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
8435 will set the context for newly created files only.
8436 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
8440 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
8441 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
8449 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
8452 @cindex converting while copying a file
8454 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
8455 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
8456 conversions on it. Synopses:
8459 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
8463 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
8464 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
8465 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
8472 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
8476 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
8477 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
8478 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
8480 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
8482 @cindex block size of input
8483 @cindex input block size
8484 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
8485 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
8486 The default is 512 bytes.
8488 @item obs=@var{bytes}
8490 @cindex block size of output
8491 @cindex output block size
8492 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
8493 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
8494 The default is 512 bytes.
8496 @item bs=@var{bytes}
8499 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
8500 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
8501 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
8502 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} option is specified,
8503 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
8504 even if it is smaller than the block size.
8506 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
8508 @cindex block size of conversion
8509 @cindex conversion block size
8510 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
8511 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
8512 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
8513 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
8514 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
8515 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
8519 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
8520 If @samp{iflag=skip_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8521 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8525 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
8526 if @samp{oflag=seek_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8527 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8531 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
8532 of everything until the end of the file.
8533 if @samp{iflag=count_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8534 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8535 Note if the input may return short reads as could be the case
8536 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
8537 will ensure that @samp{count=} corresponds to complete input blocks
8538 rather than the traditional POSIX specified behavior of counting
8539 input read operations.
8541 @item status=@var{level}
8543 Transfer information is normally output to stderr upon
8544 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits.
8545 Specifying @var{level} will adjust the amount of information printed,
8546 with the last @var{level} specified taking precedence.
8551 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
8552 Do not print any informational or warning messages to stderr.
8553 Error messages are output as normal.
8556 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
8557 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
8558 that normally make up the last status line.
8561 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
8562 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on stderr,
8563 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
8564 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
8565 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
8569 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
8571 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
8572 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8579 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
8580 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
8581 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8582 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
8583 This option implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
8584 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
8587 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8588 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
8589 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
8590 This option implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
8591 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
8594 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8595 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
8596 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8597 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
8598 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
8600 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
8601 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these options, you should also
8602 use the @samp{cbs=} option.
8605 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
8606 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
8607 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
8611 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
8612 and append a newline.
8614 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8617 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
8618 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
8621 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
8622 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
8624 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8628 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
8629 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
8630 sparse output when extending the output file.
8631 Be careful when using this option in conjunction with
8632 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
8633 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
8634 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
8635 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
8636 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
8637 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this option
8638 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
8641 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
8642 @cindex byte-swapping
8643 Swap every pair of input bytes. GNU @command{dd}, unlike others, works
8644 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
8645 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
8648 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
8649 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
8650 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
8655 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
8656 and don't affect internal processing:
8661 @cindex creating output file, requiring
8662 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
8667 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
8668 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
8670 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8674 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
8675 Do not truncate the output file.
8679 @cindex read errors, ignoring
8680 Continue after read errors.
8684 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
8685 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
8686 write of output data.
8690 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
8691 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
8692 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
8696 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8698 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8699 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8701 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8703 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8704 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8706 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
8713 @cindex appending to the output file
8714 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
8715 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
8716 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
8717 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
8718 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
8719 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
8723 @cindex concurrent I/O
8724 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
8725 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
8726 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
8732 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
8733 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
8734 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
8735 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
8736 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
8740 @cindex directory I/O
8742 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
8743 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
8747 @cindex synchronized data reads
8748 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
8749 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
8750 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
8751 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
8752 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
8756 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
8757 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
8761 @cindex discarding file cache
8762 Request to discard the system data cache for a file.
8763 When count=0 all cached data for the file is specified,
8764 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
8765 portion of the file. Also when count=0,
8766 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
8767 and reflected in the exit status.
8769 Note data that is not already persisted to storage will not
8770 be discarded from cache, so note the use of the ``sync'' options
8771 in the examples below, which are used to maximize the
8772 effectiveness of the @samp{nocache} flag.
8774 Here are some usage examples:
8777 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
8778 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
8780 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
8781 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
8783 # Drop cache for part of file
8784 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
8786 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache.
8787 # See also the @samp{direct} flag.
8788 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache,sync
8793 @cindex nonblocking I/O
8794 Use non-blocking I/O.
8799 Do not update the file's access time.
8800 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
8801 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
8805 @cindex controlling terminal
8806 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
8807 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
8808 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
8813 @cindex symbolic links, following
8814 Do not follow symbolic links.
8819 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
8824 Use binary I/O@. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
8825 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
8830 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
8835 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
8836 may return early if a full block is not available.
8837 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
8839 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8840 This flag is useful with pipes for example
8841 as they may return short reads. In that case,
8842 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
8843 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
8846 @opindex count_bytes
8847 Interpret the @samp{count=} operand as a byte count,
8848 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8849 a length that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8850 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8854 Interpret the @samp{skip=} operand as a byte count,
8855 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8856 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8857 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8861 Interpret the @samp{seek=} operand as a byte count,
8862 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8863 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8864 This flag can be used only with @code{oflag}.
8868 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
8869 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
8870 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
8871 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
8872 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
8873 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
8877 @cindex multipliers after numbers
8878 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
8879 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
8880 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
8881 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
8883 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
8884 should not be too large---values larger than a few megabytes
8885 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
8886 counterproductive or error-inducing.
8888 To process data that is at an offset or size that is not a
8889 multiple of the I/O@ block size, you can use the @samp{skip_bytes},
8890 @samp{seek_bytes} and @samp{count_bytes} flags. Alternatively
8891 the traditional method of separate @command{dd} invocations can be used.
8892 For example, the following shell commands copy data
8893 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save
8894 or restore a 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
8897 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
8900 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
8901 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
8903 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
8904 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
8908 @cindex disks, failing
8909 For failing disks, other tools come with a great variety of extra
8910 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
8911 disk finally dies, e.g.
8912 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
8913 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
8914 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
8915 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
8916 example: the options @samp{conv=noerror,sync} are used to continue
8917 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
8918 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
8919 occur on disk based devices):
8922 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing disk.
8923 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
8926 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
8927 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
8928 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
8929 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
8930 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
8931 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
8932 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
8935 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
8936 # Note this is not needed when SIGINFO is available.
8939 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
8940 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
8941 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
8943 # Output stats every second.
8944 while kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep 1; done
8947 The above script will output in the following format:
8950 3441325+0 records in
8951 3441325+0 records out
8952 3441325000 bytes (3.4 GB, 3.2 GiB) copied, 1.00036 s, 3.4 GB/s
8953 5000000+0 records in
8954 5000000+0 records out
8955 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB, 4.7 GiB) copied, 1.44433 s, 3.5 GB/s
8958 The @samp{status=progress} option periodically updates the last line
8959 of the transfer statistics above.
8961 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
8962 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
8963 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
8964 environment variable is set.
8969 @node install invocation
8970 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
8973 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
8975 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
8976 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
8979 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8980 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8981 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8982 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
8987 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
8991 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8992 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8993 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8994 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
8995 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
8998 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
8999 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
9000 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
9001 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
9002 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
9003 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
9006 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
9007 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
9008 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
9009 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
9010 files onto themselves.
9012 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
9013 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
9015 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9025 Compare each pair of source and destination files, and if the destination has
9026 identical content and any specified owner, group, permissions, and possibly
9027 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
9028 Note this option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
9029 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
9030 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
9031 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
9032 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
9037 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
9041 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
9042 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
9043 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
9044 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
9049 @opindex --directory
9050 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
9051 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
9052 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
9053 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
9054 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
9055 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
9057 @item -g @var{group}
9058 @itemx --group=@var{group}
9061 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
9062 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
9063 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
9064 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
9067 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9070 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
9071 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
9072 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
9073 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
9074 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
9075 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
9076 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
9077 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
9078 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
9079 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
9080 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
9082 @item -o @var{owner}
9083 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
9086 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
9087 @cindex appropriate privileges
9088 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
9089 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
9090 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
9091 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
9094 @item --preserve-context
9095 @opindex --preserve-context
9097 @cindex security context
9098 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
9099 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
9100 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
9101 print a warning and ignore the option.
9104 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
9106 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
9107 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
9108 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
9109 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
9110 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
9111 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
9112 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
9113 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
9114 to when they were last installed.
9120 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
9121 @cindex stripping symbol table information
9122 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
9124 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
9125 @opindex --strip-program
9126 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
9127 Program used to strip binaries.
9132 Also specifying the @option{-D} option will ensure the directory is present.
9134 @optNoTargetDirectory
9140 Print the name of each file before copying it.
9143 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
9152 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
9156 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
9159 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
9160 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
9161 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
9166 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
9170 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9171 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9172 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9173 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
9174 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
9177 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
9178 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
9179 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
9180 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
9181 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
9182 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
9183 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
9184 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
9185 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
9186 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
9187 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
9188 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
9191 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
9192 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
9193 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
9194 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9196 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
9197 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
9198 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
9199 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
9200 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
9201 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9203 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
9204 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
9205 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
9206 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
9207 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
9208 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
9209 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
9210 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
9211 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
9213 @emph{Note}: @command{mv} will only replace empty directories in the
9214 destination. Conflicting populated directories are skipped with a diagnostic.
9216 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9226 @cindex prompts, omitting
9227 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
9229 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
9230 options, only the final one takes effect.
9235 @itemx --interactive
9237 @opindex --interactive
9238 @cindex prompts, forcing
9239 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
9241 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9247 @opindex --no-clobber
9248 @cindex prompts, omitting
9249 Do not overwrite an existing file.
9251 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
9257 @cindex newer files, moving only
9258 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9259 same or newer modification time.
9260 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
9261 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
9262 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
9263 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
9264 same source and destination.
9270 Print the name of each file before moving it.
9272 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9278 @optNoTargetDirectory
9284 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
9285 @cindex security context
9286 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
9287 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
9288 to the system default type for destination files and each created directory.
9296 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
9299 @cindex removing files or directories
9301 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
9302 directories. Synopsis:
9305 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9308 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
9309 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
9310 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
9311 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
9312 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
9313 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
9315 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
9316 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
9317 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
9318 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
9319 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9321 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
9322 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
9325 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
9326 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
9327 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
9329 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9337 @cindex directories, removing
9338 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
9344 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
9345 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
9349 Prompt whether to remove each file.
9350 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9351 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
9352 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
9356 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
9357 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
9358 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
9359 @option{--interactive=once}.
9361 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
9362 @opindex --interactive
9363 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
9367 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
9368 - Do not prompt at all.
9370 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
9371 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
9372 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
9374 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
9375 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
9377 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
9378 @option{--interactive=always}.
9380 @item --one-file-system
9381 @opindex --one-file-system
9382 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
9383 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
9384 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
9387 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
9388 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
9389 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
9390 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
9391 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
9392 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
9393 under @file{/home}, too.
9394 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
9395 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
9396 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
9397 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
9399 @item --preserve-root
9400 @opindex --preserve-root
9401 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
9402 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
9403 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
9404 This is the default behavior.
9405 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9407 @item --no-preserve-root
9408 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9409 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
9410 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
9411 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
9412 remove all the files on your computer.
9413 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9420 @opindex --recursive
9421 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
9422 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
9428 Print the name of each file before removing it.
9432 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
9433 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
9434 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
9435 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
9436 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
9437 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
9438 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
9451 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
9452 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
9453 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
9458 @node shred invocation
9459 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
9462 @cindex data, erasing
9463 @cindex erasing data
9465 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
9466 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
9468 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
9469 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
9470 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
9471 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
9472 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
9474 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
9475 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
9476 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
9477 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
9479 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
9480 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
9481 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
9482 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
9485 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
9486 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
9487 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
9488 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
9489 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
9491 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
9492 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
9493 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
9494 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
9495 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
9496 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
9497 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
9498 California, July 22--25, 1996).
9500 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
9501 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
9502 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
9503 assumption. Exceptions include:
9508 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
9509 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
9510 BFS, NTFS, etc., when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
9513 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
9514 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
9517 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
9520 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
9524 Compressed file systems.
9527 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
9528 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
9529 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
9530 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
9531 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
9532 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
9533 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
9534 the mount man page (man mount).
9536 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
9537 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
9538 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
9540 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
9541 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
9542 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
9543 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
9544 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
9547 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
9548 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
9549 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
9550 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
9551 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
9554 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
9555 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
9556 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
9557 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
9558 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
9561 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
9564 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9572 @cindex force deletion
9573 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
9575 @item -n @var{number}
9576 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
9577 @opindex -n @var{number}
9578 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
9579 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
9580 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
9581 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
9582 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
9583 been used at least once.
9585 @item --random-source=@var{file}
9586 @opindex --random-source
9587 @cindex random source for shredding
9588 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
9589 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
9591 @item -s @var{bytes}
9592 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
9593 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
9594 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
9595 @cindex size of file to shred
9596 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
9597 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
9598 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
9601 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
9604 @opindex --remove=unlink
9605 @opindex --remove=wipe
9606 @opindex --remove=wipesync
9607 @cindex removing files after shredding
9608 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
9609 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
9610 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
9611 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
9612 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
9613 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
9614 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
9615 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to disk.
9616 Note @samp{wipesync} is the default method, but can be expensive,
9617 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
9618 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
9619 synchronous metadata updates.
9625 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
9631 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
9632 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
9633 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
9634 system memory on some systems for example.
9635 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
9636 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
9637 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
9638 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
9644 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
9645 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
9646 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
9647 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
9648 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
9649 by the @option{--iterations} option.
9653 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
9654 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
9655 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
9659 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
9662 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
9663 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
9666 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
9669 On modern disks, a single pass should be adequate,
9670 and it will take one third the time of the default three-pass approach.
9673 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
9674 shred --verbose -n1 /dev/sda5
9677 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
9678 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
9679 in case some disk controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
9680 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
9681 Some SSDs may do just that.
9683 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
9684 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
9691 echo "Hello, world" >&3
9696 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
9697 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
9698 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
9699 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
9704 @node Special file types
9705 @chapter Special file types
9707 @cindex special file types
9708 @cindex file types, special
9710 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
9711 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
9713 @cindex special file types
9715 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
9716 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
9717 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
9718 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
9719 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
9720 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
9721 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
9722 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
9724 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
9725 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
9728 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9729 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
9730 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
9731 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
9732 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
9733 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
9734 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
9735 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9739 @node link invocation
9740 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9743 @cindex links, creating
9744 @cindex hard links, creating
9745 @cindex creating links (hard only)
9747 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
9748 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9749 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
9750 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9751 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9752 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
9756 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
9759 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
9760 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
9761 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
9764 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
9765 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
9766 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
9767 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
9768 more portable in practice.
9770 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
9771 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
9772 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
9773 to specify which behavior is desired.
9779 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
9782 @cindex links, creating
9783 @cindex hard links, creating
9784 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
9785 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
9787 @cindex file systems and hard links
9788 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
9789 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
9793 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
9794 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
9795 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
9796 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
9802 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
9803 file from the second.
9806 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
9807 in the current directory.
9810 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9811 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9812 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9813 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
9814 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
9818 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
9819 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
9820 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
9821 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
9824 @cindex hard link, defined
9825 @cindex inode, and hard links
9826 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
9827 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
9828 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
9829 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
9830 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
9831 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
9832 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
9833 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
9834 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
9836 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
9837 @cindex symbolic link, defined
9838 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
9839 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
9840 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
9841 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
9842 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
9843 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
9844 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
9845 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
9846 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
9847 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
9848 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
9849 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
9850 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
9851 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
9852 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9854 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
9855 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
9856 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
9857 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
9858 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
9859 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
9860 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
9861 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
9862 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
9863 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
9864 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
9867 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
9868 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
9869 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
9870 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
9871 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
9872 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
9873 what will be placed in the symlink.
9875 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9886 @opindex --directory
9887 @cindex hard links to directories
9888 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
9890 However, note that this will probably fail due to
9891 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
9897 Remove existing destination files.
9900 @itemx --interactive
9902 @opindex --interactive
9903 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
9904 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
9910 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9911 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
9912 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
9915 @itemx --no-dereference
9917 @opindex --no-dereference
9918 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
9919 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
9921 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
9922 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
9923 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
9924 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
9925 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
9926 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
9927 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
9928 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
9929 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
9930 just like a directory.
9932 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
9933 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
9939 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9940 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
9941 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
9942 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
9943 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
9944 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
9950 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
9955 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
9956 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
9959 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
9960 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
9961 links in these file names will be resolved.
9962 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
9963 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
9968 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
9970 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
9971 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
9972 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
9973 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
9982 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
9983 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9989 @optNoTargetDirectory
9995 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
9999 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
10000 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
10001 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
10002 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
10003 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
10004 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
10005 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
10006 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
10015 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
10016 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
10021 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
10027 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
10028 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
10032 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
10033 # work across networked file systems.
10034 ln -s afile anotherfile
10035 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
10039 @node mkdir invocation
10040 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
10043 @cindex directories, creating
10044 @cindex creating directories
10046 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
10049 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
10052 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
10053 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
10054 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
10056 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10060 @item -m @var{mode}
10061 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10064 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
10065 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
10066 which uses the same syntax as
10067 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
10068 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
10070 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
10071 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
10072 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
10073 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
10074 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
10075 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
10076 overridden in this way.
10082 @cindex parent directories, creating
10083 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
10084 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
10085 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
10088 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
10089 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
10090 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
10091 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
10092 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
10093 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
10094 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
10095 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
10096 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
10102 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
10103 @option{--parents}.
10112 @node mkfifo invocation
10113 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
10116 @cindex FIFOs, creating
10117 @cindex named pipes, creating
10118 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
10120 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
10121 specified names. Synopsis:
10124 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
10127 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
10128 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
10129 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
10130 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
10132 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10136 @item -m @var{mode}
10137 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10140 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
10141 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
10142 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
10143 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
10144 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
10153 @node mknod invocation
10154 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
10157 @cindex block special files, creating
10158 @cindex character special files, creating
10160 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
10161 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
10164 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
10167 @cindex special files
10168 @cindex block special files
10169 @cindex character special files
10170 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
10171 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
10172 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
10173 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
10174 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
10175 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
10176 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
10177 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
10179 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
10180 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
10182 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
10187 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
10191 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
10192 for a block special file
10195 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
10196 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
10198 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
10199 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
10200 for a character special file
10204 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
10205 device numbers must be given after the file type.
10206 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
10207 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
10208 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
10210 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10214 @item -m @var{mode}
10215 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10218 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
10219 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
10220 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
10221 @xref{File permissions}.
10230 @node readlink invocation
10231 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
10234 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
10235 @cindex canonical file name
10236 @cindex canonicalize a file name
10239 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
10243 @item Readlink mode
10245 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
10246 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
10247 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
10249 @item Canonicalize mode
10251 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
10252 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
10253 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
10258 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10261 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
10263 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10268 @itemx --canonicalize
10270 @opindex --canonicalize
10271 Activate canonicalize mode.
10272 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
10273 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
10274 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
10277 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
10279 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
10280 Activate canonicalize mode.
10281 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
10282 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
10283 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
10286 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
10288 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
10289 Activate canonicalize mode.
10290 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
10294 @itemx --no-newline
10296 @opindex --no-newline
10297 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
10298 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
10308 Suppress most error messages. On by default.
10314 Report error messages.
10320 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
10322 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
10323 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
10328 @node rmdir invocation
10329 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
10332 @cindex removing empty directories
10333 @cindex directories, removing empty
10335 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
10338 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
10341 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
10342 directory, it is an error.
10344 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10348 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10349 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10350 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
10351 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
10352 the directory is non-empty.
10358 @cindex parent directories, removing
10359 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
10360 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
10361 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
10362 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
10363 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
10364 exit unsuccessfully.
10370 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
10371 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
10372 @var{directory} is removed.
10376 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
10381 @node unlink invocation
10382 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10385 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
10387 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
10388 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10389 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
10390 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
10391 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10392 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
10395 unlink @var{filename}
10398 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
10399 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
10400 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
10402 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
10403 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
10404 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
10409 @node Changing file attributes
10410 @chapter Changing file attributes
10412 @cindex changing file attributes
10413 @cindex file attributes, changing
10414 @cindex attributes, file
10416 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
10417 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
10418 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
10419 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
10420 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
10423 These commands change file attributes.
10426 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
10427 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
10428 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
10429 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
10433 @node chown invocation
10434 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
10437 @cindex file ownership, changing
10438 @cindex group ownership, changing
10439 @cindex changing file ownership
10440 @cindex changing group ownership
10442 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
10443 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
10447 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10451 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
10452 (with no embedded white space):
10455 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
10462 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
10463 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
10466 @item owner@samp{:}group
10467 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
10468 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
10469 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
10471 @item owner@samp{:}
10472 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
10473 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
10474 @var{owner}'s login group.
10476 @item @samp{:}group
10477 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
10478 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
10479 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
10482 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
10483 owner nor the group is changed.
10487 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
10488 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10489 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10491 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
10492 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
10493 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
10494 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
10495 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
10496 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
10497 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
10500 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
10501 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
10502 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
10503 which the user is a member.
10505 @chownGroupRestrictions
10507 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
10508 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
10509 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
10510 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
10511 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
10512 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
10513 privileges, or when the
10514 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
10515 mandatory locking).
10516 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10518 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10526 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
10527 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
10536 @cindex error messages, omitting
10537 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
10540 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
10542 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10543 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
10544 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
10546 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
10547 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
10548 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
10549 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
10552 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
10555 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
10556 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
10557 may be quite large.
10558 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
10562 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
10565 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
10566 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
10567 though still not perfect:
10570 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
10573 @item --dereference
10574 @opindex --dereference
10575 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10577 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10578 This is the default.
10581 @itemx --no-dereference
10583 @opindex --no-dereference
10584 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10586 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10587 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10588 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10589 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
10590 is a symbolic link.
10591 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10592 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10594 @item --preserve-root
10595 @opindex --preserve-root
10596 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10597 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10598 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10599 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10601 @item --no-preserve-root
10602 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10603 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10604 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10605 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10607 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10608 @opindex --reference
10609 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
10610 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10611 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
10618 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10619 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10620 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10621 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10622 its referent is being changed.
10627 @opindex --recursive
10628 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
10629 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
10632 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10635 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10638 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10647 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
10650 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
10651 chown root:staff /u
10653 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
10658 @node chgrp invocation
10659 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
10662 @cindex group ownership, changing
10663 @cindex changing group ownership
10665 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
10666 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
10667 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
10671 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10675 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
10676 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10677 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10679 @chownGroupRestrictions
10681 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10689 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
10690 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
10699 @cindex error messages, omitting
10700 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
10703 @item --dereference
10704 @opindex --dereference
10705 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10707 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10708 This is the default.
10711 @itemx --no-dereference
10713 @opindex --no-dereference
10714 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
10716 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10717 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10718 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10719 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
10720 is a symbolic link.
10721 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10722 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10724 @item --preserve-root
10725 @opindex --preserve-root
10726 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10727 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10728 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10729 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10731 @item --no-preserve-root
10732 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10733 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10734 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10735 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10737 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10738 @opindex --reference
10739 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
10740 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10741 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10747 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10748 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10749 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10750 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10751 its referent is being changed.
10756 @opindex --recursive
10757 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
10758 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
10761 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10764 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10767 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10776 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
10779 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
10784 @node chmod invocation
10785 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
10788 @cindex changing access permissions
10789 @cindex access permissions, changing
10790 @cindex permissions, changing access
10792 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
10795 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10799 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
10800 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
10801 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
10802 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
10803 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
10804 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
10805 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
10806 recursive directory traversals.
10808 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
10809 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
10810 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
10811 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
10812 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
10813 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
10814 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
10815 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10817 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
10818 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
10819 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
10820 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
10821 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
10822 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
10823 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
10825 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10833 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
10842 @cindex error messages, omitting
10843 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
10846 @item --preserve-root
10847 @opindex --preserve-root
10848 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10849 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10850 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10851 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10853 @item --no-preserve-root
10854 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10855 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10856 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10857 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10863 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
10865 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10866 @opindex --reference
10867 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
10868 @xref{File permissions}.
10869 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
10870 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10875 @opindex --recursive
10876 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
10877 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
10884 @node touch invocation
10885 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
10888 @cindex changing file timestamps
10889 @cindex file timestamps, changing
10890 @cindex timestamps, changing file
10892 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
10893 specified files. Synopsis:
10896 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10899 @cindex empty files, creating
10900 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
10901 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
10902 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
10904 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
10905 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
10909 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
10910 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
10911 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
10912 Also, the determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
10913 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
10914 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
10915 @command{touch} typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
10916 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
10917 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
10919 @cindex file timestamp resolution
10920 The @command{touch} command sets the file's timestamp to the greatest
10921 representable value that is not greater than the requested time. This
10922 can differ from the requested time for several reasons. First, the
10923 requested time may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a
10924 file system may use different resolutions for different types of
10925 times. Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than
10926 operating system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives
10927 used to update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For
10928 example, in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution
10929 for access time and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification time,
10930 and the operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the
10931 current time and microsecond resolution for the primitive that
10932 @command{touch} uses to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
10934 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
10935 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
10936 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
10937 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
10938 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
10939 unless both the access and modification times are being set to the
10942 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
10943 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
10944 a standard third one as well: the inode change time. This is often
10945 referred to as a file's @code{ctime}.
10946 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
10947 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
10948 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
10949 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
10950 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
10951 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
10952 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
10953 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
10954 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
10955 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
10956 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
10957 Some operating systems and file systems support a fourth time: the
10958 birth time, when the file was first created; by definition, this
10959 timestamp never changes.
10962 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
10963 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
10964 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
10965 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10966 You can avoid ambiguities during
10967 daylight saving transitions by using UTC time stamps.
10969 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10974 @itemx --time=atime
10975 @itemx --time=access
10979 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
10980 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
10981 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
10982 Change the access time only.
10987 @opindex --no-create
10988 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
10990 @item -d @var{time}
10991 @itemx --date=@var{time}
10995 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
10996 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
10997 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
10998 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
10999 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
11000 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
11001 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
11002 silently ignore any excess precision here.
11006 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
11007 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
11010 @itemx --no-dereference
11012 @opindex --no-dereference
11013 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
11015 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
11016 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
11017 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
11018 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
11019 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
11020 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
11021 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
11022 time, such that only changes to the modification time will persist
11023 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
11024 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
11028 @itemx --time=mtime
11029 @itemx --time=modify
11032 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
11033 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
11034 Change the modification time only.
11036 @item -r @var{file}
11037 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
11039 @opindex --reference
11040 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
11041 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
11042 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
11043 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
11044 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
11045 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
11046 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
11047 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
11049 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
11050 @cindex leap seconds
11051 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
11052 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
11053 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
11054 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
11055 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
11056 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
11057 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
11062 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
11063 On systems predating POSIX 1003.1-2001,
11064 @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
11065 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
11066 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
11067 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
11068 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
11069 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
11070 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
11071 for the other files instead of as a file name.
11072 Although this obsolete behavior can be controlled with the
11073 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
11074 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
11075 behavior depends on this variable.
11076 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
11077 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
11083 @chapter Disk usage
11087 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
11088 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
11089 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
11092 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
11093 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
11094 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
11095 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
11096 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
11100 @node df invocation
11101 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
11104 @cindex file system disk usage
11105 @cindex disk usage by file system
11107 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
11108 file systems. Synopsis:
11111 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11114 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
11115 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
11116 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
11118 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
11119 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
11120 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
11122 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
11123 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
11124 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
11127 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
11128 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
11129 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
11130 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
11132 @cindex disk device file
11133 @cindex device file, disk
11134 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
11135 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
11136 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
11137 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
11138 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
11139 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
11141 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11149 @cindex ignore file systems
11150 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
11151 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
11152 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
11153 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
11154 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
11155 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
11156 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
11157 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
11159 @item -B @var{size}
11160 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
11162 @opindex --block-size
11163 @cindex file system sizes
11164 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
11165 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
11171 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
11177 @cindex inode usage
11178 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
11179 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
11180 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
11184 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
11185 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11186 (@pxref{Block size}).
11187 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11193 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11194 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
11199 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
11200 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
11201 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
11202 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
11203 out of date. This is the default.
11206 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
11208 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
11209 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
11210 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
11212 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
11213 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
11215 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
11216 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
11217 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
11220 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
11223 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
11228 Total number of inodes.
11230 Number of used inodes.
11232 Number of available inodes.
11234 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
11237 Total number of blocks.
11239 Number of used blocks.
11241 Number of available blocks.
11243 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
11246 The file name if specified on the command line.
11251 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
11252 options like @option{-h} as usual.
11254 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
11255 @option{--output} uses.
11259 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
11260 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
11261 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
11263 # Print all available fields.
11269 @itemx --portability
11271 @opindex --portability
11272 @cindex one-line output format
11273 @cindex POSIX output format
11274 @cindex portable output format
11275 @cindex output format, portable
11276 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
11281 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
11282 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
11283 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
11284 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
11287 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
11290 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
11291 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
11292 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
11293 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
11294 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
11301 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
11302 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
11303 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
11304 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
11305 there are many or very busy file systems.
11309 @cindex grand total of disk size, usage and available space
11310 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11311 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk size, usage
11312 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
11313 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
11314 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
11316 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
11317 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
11318 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
11319 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
11322 @item -t @var{fstype}
11323 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
11326 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11327 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
11328 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
11329 By default, nothing is omitted.
11332 @itemx --print-type
11334 @opindex --print-type
11335 @cindex file system types, printing
11336 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
11337 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
11338 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
11339 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
11344 @cindex NFS file system type
11345 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
11346 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
11349 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
11350 @cindex Linux file system types
11351 @cindex local file system types
11352 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
11353 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
11354 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
11355 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
11356 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
11357 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
11358 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
11360 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
11361 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
11362 @cindex DVD file system type
11363 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
11364 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
11365 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
11366 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
11367 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
11370 @cindex NTFS file system
11371 @cindex DOS file system
11372 @cindex MS-DOS file system
11373 @cindex MS-Windows file system
11374 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
11375 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
11376 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
11380 @item -x @var{fstype}
11381 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
11383 @opindex --exclude-type
11384 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
11385 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
11386 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
11389 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
11393 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
11394 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
11397 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
11398 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
11399 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
11400 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
11402 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
11403 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
11404 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
11405 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
11408 @node du invocation
11409 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
11412 @cindex file space usage
11413 @cindex disk usage for files
11415 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the set of specified files
11416 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
11419 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11422 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
11423 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
11424 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
11425 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
11427 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
11428 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
11429 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
11430 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
11432 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11442 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
11444 @item --apparent-size
11445 @opindex --apparent-size
11446 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
11447 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
11448 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
11449 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
11450 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
11451 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
11452 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
11453 However, a sparse file created with this command:
11456 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
11460 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
11461 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
11463 @item -B @var{size}
11464 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
11466 @opindex --block-size
11468 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
11469 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
11475 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
11481 @cindex grand total of disk space
11482 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11483 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
11484 a given set of files or directories.
11487 @itemx --dereference-args
11489 @opindex --dereference-args
11490 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
11491 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
11492 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
11493 are often symbolic links.
11495 @item -d @var{depth}
11496 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
11497 @opindex -d @var{depth}
11498 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
11499 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
11500 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
11501 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
11502 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
11504 @c --files0-from=FILE
11505 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
11509 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
11515 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
11516 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
11517 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
11518 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
11519 option @option{--inodes}).
11520 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
11521 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
11522 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
11523 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
11527 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
11528 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11529 (@pxref{Block size}).
11530 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11533 @itemx --dereference
11535 @opindex --dereference
11536 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11537 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
11538 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
11542 @itemx --count-links
11544 @opindex --count-links
11545 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
11546 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
11551 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
11552 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11553 (@pxref{Block size}).
11554 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
11557 @itemx --no-dereference
11559 @opindex --no-dereference
11560 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11561 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
11562 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
11565 @itemx --separate-dirs
11567 @opindex --separate-dirs
11568 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
11569 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
11570 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
11571 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
11572 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
11579 @opindex --summarize
11580 Display only a total for each argument.
11582 @item -t @var{size}
11583 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
11585 @opindex --threshold
11586 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
11587 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
11588 with the @option{--inodes} option.
11590 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11591 greater than or equal to that.
11593 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11594 smaller than or equal to that.
11596 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
11597 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
11598 directories based on a given size.
11600 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11601 @option{--apparent-size} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11604 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11605 @option{--inodes} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11608 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
11609 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
11612 du --threshold=200MB
11615 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and files -
11616 note the @option{-a} - with an apparent size smaller than or equal to 500 bytes:
11619 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
11622 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
11623 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
11626 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
11632 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
11633 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
11634 or any of its subdirectories.
11637 @itemx --time=status
11640 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
11641 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
11642 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
11643 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
11644 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11647 @itemx --time=access
11649 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
11650 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
11651 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
11652 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11654 @item --time-style=@var{style}
11655 @opindex --time-style
11657 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
11658 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
11659 be one of the following:
11662 @item +@var{format}
11664 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
11665 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
11666 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
11667 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
11668 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
11669 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
11672 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
11673 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
11674 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
11675 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
11678 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
11679 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
11680 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
11681 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
11684 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
11685 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
11689 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
11690 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
11691 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
11692 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
11693 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
11694 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
11695 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
11697 @item -X @var{file}
11698 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
11699 @opindex -X @var{file}
11700 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
11701 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11702 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
11703 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
11706 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
11707 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
11708 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11709 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
11710 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
11714 @itemx --one-file-system
11716 @opindex --one-file-system
11717 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
11718 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
11719 the argument being processed is on.
11723 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
11724 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
11725 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
11726 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
11727 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
11728 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
11733 @node stat invocation
11734 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
11737 @cindex file status
11738 @cindex file system status
11740 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
11743 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11746 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
11747 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
11748 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
11749 also give information about the files the links point to.
11751 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
11756 @itemx --dereference
11758 @opindex --dereference
11759 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
11760 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
11761 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
11762 by each symbolic link argument.
11763 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
11766 @itemx --file-system
11768 @opindex --file-system
11769 @cindex file systems
11770 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
11771 instead of information about the files themselves.
11772 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
11775 @itemx --format=@var{format}
11777 @opindex --format=@var{format}
11778 @cindex output format
11779 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11780 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
11781 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
11782 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
11784 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
11789 @item --printf=@var{format}
11790 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
11791 @cindex output format
11792 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11793 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
11794 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
11795 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
11796 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
11797 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
11799 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
11808 @cindex terse output
11809 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
11811 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
11812 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
11813 Note the format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
11814 active SELinux security context.
11816 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
11820 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
11822 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
11823 $ stat -f --terse ...
11827 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
11828 @option{--printf} are:
11831 @item %a - Access rights in octal (note @samp{#} and @samp{0} printf flags)
11832 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
11833 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
11834 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
11835 @item %C - The SELinux security context of a file, if available
11836 @item %d - Device number in decimal
11837 @item %D - Device number in hex
11838 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
11839 @item %F - File type
11840 @item %g - Group ID of owner
11841 @item %G - Group name of owner
11842 @item %h - Number of hard links
11843 @item %i - Inode number
11844 @item %m - Mount point (See note below)
11845 @item %n - File name
11846 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link (see below)
11847 @item %o - Optimal I/O transfer size hint
11848 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
11849 @item %t - Major device type in hex (see below)
11850 @item %T - Minor device type in hex (see below)
11851 @item %u - User ID of owner
11852 @item %U - User name of owner
11853 @item %w - Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
11854 @item %W - Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
11855 @item %x - Time of last access
11856 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
11857 @item %y - Time of last data modification
11858 @item %Y - Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
11859 @item %z - Time of last status change
11860 @item %Z - Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
11863 The @samp{%a} format prints the octal mode, and so it is useful
11864 to control the zero padding of the output with the @samp{#} and @samp{0}
11865 printf flags. For example to pad to at least 3 wide while making larger
11866 numbers unambiguously octal, you can use @samp{%#03a}.
11868 The @samp{%N} format can be set with the environment variable
11869 @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment variable is not set,
11870 the default value is @samp{shell-escape}. Valid quoting styles are:
11873 The @samp{%t} and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev member of
11874 the stat(2) structure, and are only defined for character and block
11875 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
11876 represent other quantities.
11878 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
11879 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
11880 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
11881 last access time to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
11882 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
11883 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, time stamps are truncated
11884 toward minus infinity.
11888 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
11891 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
11893 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
11896 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
11898 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
11899 [1288929712.114951834]
11902 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
11903 by @command{df}, except that:
11906 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
11907 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
11909 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
11910 file system list, instead operating on them directly
11913 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
11914 the initial mount point of its backing device.
11915 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
11916 to get the current base mount point
11919 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
11920 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
11923 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
11924 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
11925 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
11926 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
11927 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
11928 @item %i - File System ID in hex
11929 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
11930 @item %n - File name
11931 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
11932 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
11933 @item %t - Type in hex
11934 @item %T - Type in human readable form
11938 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
11939 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
11940 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
11941 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
11946 @node sync invocation
11947 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11950 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
11951 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11953 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
11957 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
11960 @cindex superblock, writing
11961 @cindex inodes, written buffered
11962 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
11963 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
11964 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
11965 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
11966 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
11968 @cindex crashes and corruption
11969 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
11970 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
11971 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
11972 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
11973 data in memory to persistent storage.
11975 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
11976 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
11978 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
11979 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
11980 @ref{Common options}.
11986 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
11987 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
11990 @itemx --file-system
11991 @opindex --file-system
11992 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
11993 using the syscall syncfs(2). Note you would usually @emph{not} specify
11994 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
11995 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
11996 Note also that depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
11997 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
11998 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
11999 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
12005 @node truncate invocation
12006 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
12009 @cindex truncating, file sizes
12011 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
12012 specified size. Synopsis:
12015 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
12018 @cindex files, creating
12019 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
12021 @cindex sparse files, creating
12022 @cindex holes, creating files with
12023 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
12024 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
12025 reads as zero bytes.
12027 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12034 @opindex --no-create
12035 Do not create files that do not exist.
12040 @opindex --io-blocks
12041 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
12043 @item -r @var{rfile}
12044 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
12046 @opindex --reference
12047 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
12049 @item -s @var{size}
12050 @itemx --size=@var{size}
12053 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
12054 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
12055 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
12057 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
12058 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
12060 @samp{+} => extend by
12061 @samp{-} => reduce by
12062 @samp{<} => at most
12063 @samp{>} => at least
12064 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
12065 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
12073 @node Printing text
12074 @chapter Printing text
12076 @cindex printing text, commands for
12077 @cindex commands for printing text
12079 This section describes commands that display text strings.
12082 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
12083 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
12084 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
12088 @node echo invocation
12089 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
12092 @cindex displaying text
12093 @cindex printing text
12094 @cindex text, displaying
12095 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
12097 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
12098 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
12101 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
12104 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
12106 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12107 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
12108 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
12114 Do not output the trailing newline.
12118 @cindex backslash escapes
12119 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
12128 produce no further output
12144 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
12145 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
12146 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
12148 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
12149 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
12150 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
12152 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
12153 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
12158 @cindex backslash escapes
12159 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
12160 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
12161 specified, the last one given takes effect.
12165 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
12166 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
12167 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
12168 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
12169 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
12170 plain @samp{hello}.
12172 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
12173 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
12174 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
12175 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
12176 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
12177 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
12182 @node printf invocation
12183 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
12186 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
12189 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
12192 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
12193 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
12194 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
12195 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
12196 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
12197 The differences are listed below.
12199 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
12204 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
12205 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
12209 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
12210 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
12211 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
12215 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
12216 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
12217 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
12220 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
12221 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
12222 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
12223 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
12228 An additional directive @samp{%b}, prints its
12229 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
12230 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
12231 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
12232 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
12233 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
12234 from the converted string.
12238 An additional directive @samp{%q}, prints its argument string
12239 in a format that can be reused as input by most shells.
12240 Non-printable characters are escaped with the POSIX proposed @samp{$''} syntax,
12241 and shell metacharacters are quoted appropriately.
12242 This is an equivalent format to @command{ls --quoting=shell-escape} output.
12245 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
12246 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
12250 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
12251 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
12252 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
12253 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
12254 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
12255 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
12256 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
12257 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
12262 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
12263 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
12264 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
12265 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
12266 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
12267 @xref{Floating point}.
12271 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
12272 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
12273 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
12274 digits) specifying a character to print.
12275 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
12276 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
12277 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
12282 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
12284 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
12286 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (ISO/IEC 10646)
12287 characters, specified as
12288 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
12289 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
12290 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
12291 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
12292 U+0000@dots{}U+009F, U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax,
12293 except for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
12295 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
12296 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
12297 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
12298 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
12300 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
12301 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
12302 Options must precede operands.
12304 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
12305 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
12308 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
12312 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
12313 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
12316 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
12320 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
12322 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
12323 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
12324 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
12326 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
12327 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
12328 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
12329 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
12330 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
12331 this text in a locale-independent way:
12334 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
12335 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
12336 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
12337 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
12344 @node yes invocation
12345 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
12348 @cindex repeated output of a string
12350 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
12351 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
12352 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
12354 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
12356 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12357 To output an argument that begins with
12358 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
12359 @xref{Common options}.
12363 @chapter Conditions
12366 @cindex commands for exit status
12367 @cindex exit status commands
12369 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
12370 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
12371 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
12375 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
12376 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
12377 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
12378 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
12382 @node false invocation
12383 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
12386 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
12387 @cindex failure exit status
12388 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
12390 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
12391 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12392 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
12393 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
12394 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12395 command, not the one documented here.
12397 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12399 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12400 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12401 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12403 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
12404 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
12405 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12407 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
12408 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
12412 @node true invocation
12413 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
12416 @cindex do nothing, successfully
12418 @cindex successful exit
12419 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
12421 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
12422 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12423 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
12424 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
12425 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
12426 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12427 command, not the one documented here.
12429 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12431 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
12432 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
12433 option, and with standard
12434 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
12435 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
12438 $ ./true --version >&-
12439 ./true: write error: Bad file number
12440 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
12441 ./true: write error: No space left on device
12444 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12445 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12446 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12448 @node test invocation
12449 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
12452 @cindex check file types
12453 @cindex compare values
12454 @cindex expression evaluation
12456 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
12457 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
12458 expression must be a separate argument.
12460 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
12461 comparison operators.
12463 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
12464 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
12465 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
12466 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
12467 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
12468 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
12474 test @var{expression}
12476 [ @var{expression} ]
12481 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
12483 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
12484 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
12485 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
12486 otherwise. The argument
12487 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
12488 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
12489 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
12490 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
12491 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
12493 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
12497 0 if the expression is true,
12498 1 if the expression is false,
12499 2 if an error occurred.
12503 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
12504 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
12505 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
12506 * String tests:: -z -n = == !=
12507 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
12508 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
12512 @node File type tests
12513 @subsection File type tests
12515 @cindex file type tests
12517 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
12518 but not all files are the same!)
12522 @item -b @var{file}
12524 @cindex block special check
12525 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
12527 @item -c @var{file}
12529 @cindex character special check
12530 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
12532 @item -d @var{file}
12534 @cindex directory check
12535 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
12537 @item -f @var{file}
12539 @cindex regular file check
12540 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
12542 @item -h @var{file}
12543 @itemx -L @var{file}
12546 @cindex symbolic link check
12547 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
12548 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
12549 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
12551 @item -p @var{file}
12553 @cindex named pipe check
12554 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
12556 @item -S @var{file}
12558 @cindex socket check
12559 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
12563 @cindex terminal check
12564 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
12570 @node Access permission tests
12571 @subsection Access permission tests
12573 @cindex access permission tests
12574 @cindex permission tests
12576 These options test for particular access permissions.
12580 @item -g @var{file}
12582 @cindex set-group-ID check
12583 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
12585 @item -k @var{file}
12587 @cindex sticky bit check
12588 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
12590 @item -r @var{file}
12592 @cindex readable file check
12593 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
12595 @item -u @var{file}
12597 @cindex set-user-ID check
12598 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
12600 @item -w @var{file}
12602 @cindex writable file check
12603 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
12605 @item -x @var{file}
12607 @cindex executable file check
12608 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
12609 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
12611 @item -O @var{file}
12613 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
12614 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
12616 @item -G @var{file}
12618 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
12619 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
12623 @node File characteristic tests
12624 @subsection File characteristic tests
12626 @cindex file characteristic tests
12628 These options test other file characteristics.
12632 @item -e @var{file}
12634 @cindex existence-of-file check
12635 True if @var{file} exists.
12637 @item -s @var{file}
12639 @cindex nonempty file check
12640 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
12642 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
12644 @cindex newer-than file check
12645 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
12646 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
12648 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
12650 @cindex older-than file check
12651 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
12652 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
12654 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
12656 @cindex same file check
12657 @cindex hard link check
12658 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
12659 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
12665 @subsection String tests
12667 @cindex string tests
12669 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
12670 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
12676 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
12677 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
12681 @item -z @var{string}
12683 @cindex zero-length string check
12684 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
12686 @item -n @var{string}
12687 @itemx @var{string}
12689 @cindex nonzero-length string check
12690 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
12692 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
12694 @cindex equal string check
12695 True if the strings are equal.
12697 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
12699 @cindex equal string check
12700 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
12702 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
12704 @cindex not-equal string check
12705 True if the strings are not equal.
12710 @node Numeric tests
12711 @subsection Numeric tests
12713 @cindex numeric tests
12714 @cindex arithmetic tests
12716 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
12717 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
12718 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
12722 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
12723 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
12724 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
12725 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
12726 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
12727 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
12734 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
12735 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
12736 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
12743 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
12745 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
12748 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
12752 @node Connectives for test
12753 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
12755 @cindex logical connectives
12756 @cindex connectives, logical
12758 Note it's preferred to use shell logical primitives
12759 rather than these logical connectives internal to @command{test},
12760 because an expression may become ambiguous
12761 depending on the expansion of its parameters.
12763 For example, this becomes ambiguous when @samp{$1}
12764 is set to @samp{'!'} and @samp{$2} to the empty string @samp{''}:
12770 and should be written as:
12773 test "$1" && test "$2"
12776 Note the shell logical primitives also benefit from
12777 short circuit operation, which can be significant
12778 for file attribute tests.
12784 True if @var{expr} is false.
12785 @samp{!} has lower precedence than all parts of @var{expr}.
12786 Note @samp{!} needs to be specified to the left
12787 of a binary expression, I.e., @samp{'!' 1 -gt 2}
12788 rather than @samp{1 '!' -gt 2}.
12789 Also @samp{!} is often a shell special character
12790 and is best used quoted.
12793 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
12795 @cindex logical and operator
12796 @cindex and operator
12797 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
12798 @samp{-a} is left associative,
12799 and has a higher precedence than @samp{-o}.
12801 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
12803 @cindex logical or operator
12804 @cindex or operator
12805 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
12806 @samp{-o} is left associative.
12811 @node expr invocation
12812 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
12815 @cindex expression evaluation
12816 @cindex evaluation of expressions
12818 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
12819 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
12821 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
12822 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
12823 @command{expr} converts
12824 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
12825 depending on the operation being applied to it.
12827 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
12828 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
12829 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
12830 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
12831 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
12832 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
12833 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
12834 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
12835 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
12836 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
12838 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
12839 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
12840 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
12841 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
12842 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
12843 leading spaces as mentioned above.
12845 @cindex parentheses for grouping
12846 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
12847 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
12848 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
12851 When built with support for the GNU MP library, @command{expr} uses
12852 arbitrary-precision arithmetic; otherwise, it uses native arithmetic
12853 types and may fail due to arithmetic overflow.
12855 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12856 options}. Options must precede operands.
12858 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
12862 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
12863 1 if the expression is null or 0,
12864 2 if the expression is invalid,
12865 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
12869 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
12870 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
12871 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
12872 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
12876 @node String expressions
12877 @subsection String expressions
12879 @cindex string expressions
12880 @cindex expressions, string
12882 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
12883 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
12884 the next sections).
12888 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
12889 @cindex pattern matching
12890 @cindex regular expression matching
12891 @cindex matching patterns
12892 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
12893 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
12894 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
12895 then matched against this regular expression.
12897 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
12898 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
12899 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
12901 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
12902 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
12904 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
12905 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
12906 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
12907 expression operators.
12909 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
12910 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
12911 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
12912 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
12913 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
12914 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
12915 characters. (POSIX allows either behavior.)
12916 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
12917 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
12919 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
12921 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
12922 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
12924 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
12926 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
12927 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
12928 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
12930 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
12932 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
12933 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
12934 @var{string}, return 0.
12936 @item length @var{string}
12938 Returns the length of @var{string}.
12940 @item + @var{token}
12942 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
12943 or an operator like @code{/}.
12944 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
12945 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
12946 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
12947 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
12948 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
12952 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
12953 @code{quote} operator.
12956 @node Numeric expressions
12957 @subsection Numeric expressions
12959 @cindex numeric expressions
12960 @cindex expressions, numeric
12962 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
12963 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
12964 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
12965 than the connectives (next section).
12973 @cindex subtraction
12974 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
12975 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12981 @cindex multiplication
12984 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
12985 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12990 @node Relations for expr
12991 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
12993 @cindex connectives, logical
12994 @cindex logical connectives
12995 @cindex relations, numeric or string
12997 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
12998 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
12999 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
13005 @cindex logical or operator
13006 @cindex or operator
13007 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
13008 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
13009 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
13014 @cindex logical and operator
13015 @cindex and operator
13016 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
13017 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
13020 @item < <= = == != >= >
13027 @cindex comparison operators
13029 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
13030 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
13031 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
13032 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
13033 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
13038 @node Examples of expr
13039 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
13041 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
13042 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
13044 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
13047 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
13050 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
13051 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
13054 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
13057 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
13065 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
13067 expr index abcdef cz
13070 @error{} expr: syntax error
13071 expr index + index a
13077 @chapter Redirection
13079 @cindex redirection
13080 @cindex commands for redirection
13082 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
13083 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
13084 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
13085 it's described here.
13088 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
13092 @node tee invocation
13093 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
13096 @cindex pipe fitting
13097 @cindex destinations, multiple output
13098 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
13100 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
13101 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
13102 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
13105 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
13108 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
13109 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
13110 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
13112 In previous versions of GNU coreutils (v5.3.0 - v8.23), a @var{file} of @samp{-}
13113 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
13114 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
13115 conforms to POSIX which explicitly mandates it to treat @samp{-} as a file
13118 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13125 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
13129 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
13131 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
13132 Ignore interrupt signals.
13135 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
13137 @opindex --output-error
13138 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs,
13139 with the long form option supporting selection
13140 between the following @var{mode}s:
13144 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
13145 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
13146 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
13149 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
13150 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
13151 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
13152 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
13153 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
13156 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
13159 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
13164 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
13165 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
13166 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
13167 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
13168 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
13171 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
13174 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
13175 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
13176 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
13177 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
13179 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
13180 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
13181 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
13184 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
13185 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
13186 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
13189 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
13190 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
13191 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
13193 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
13194 called @dfn{process substitution}
13195 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
13196 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
13197 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
13198 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
13199 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
13200 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
13202 Note also that if any of the process substitutions (or piped stdout)
13203 might exit early without consuming all the data, the @option{-p} option
13204 is needed to allow @command{tee} to continue to process the input
13205 to any remaining outputs.
13207 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
13208 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
13211 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
13212 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
13215 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
13216 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
13217 process substitution is required:
13220 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
13221 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
13222 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
13226 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
13227 copy of the contents of a pipe.
13228 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
13229 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
13230 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
13231 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
13232 the uncompressed output.
13234 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
13235 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
13238 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
13239 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
13242 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
13243 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
13246 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
13249 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
13250 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
13251 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
13252 there may be a better way.
13253 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
13254 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
13255 (slightly simplified):
13258 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13259 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
13260 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13263 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
13264 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
13265 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
13266 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
13269 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13270 tar chof - "$tardir" \
13271 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
13272 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13275 If you want to further process the output from process substitutions,
13276 and those processes write atomically (i.e., write less than the system's
13277 PIPE_BUF size at a time), that's possible with a construct like:
13280 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13281 tar chof - "$tardir" \
13282 | tee >(md5sum --tag) > >(sha256sum --tag) \
13283 | sort | gpg --clearsign > your-pkg-M.N.tar.sig
13289 @node File name manipulation
13290 @chapter File name manipulation
13292 @cindex file name manipulation
13293 @cindex manipulation of file names
13294 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
13296 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
13299 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
13300 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
13301 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
13302 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
13303 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
13307 @node basename invocation
13308 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
13311 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
13312 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
13313 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
13314 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
13315 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
13317 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
13318 @var{name}. Synopsis:
13321 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
13322 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13325 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
13326 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
13327 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
13328 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
13331 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
13332 @macro basenameAndDirname
13333 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
13334 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
13335 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
13336 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
13338 @basenameAndDirname
13340 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13341 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
13342 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
13343 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13344 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13346 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13347 Options must precede operands.
13354 @opindex --multiple
13355 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
13356 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
13357 @option{-s} option.
13359 @item -s @var{suffix}
13360 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
13363 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
13364 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
13376 basename /usr/bin/sort
13379 basename include/stdio.h .h
13382 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
13384 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
13385 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
13389 @node dirname invocation
13390 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
13393 @cindex directory components, printing
13394 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
13395 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
13397 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
13398 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
13399 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
13400 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
13403 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
13406 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
13407 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
13408 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
13410 @basenameAndDirname
13412 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13413 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
13414 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13415 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13417 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13430 # Output "/usr/bin".
13431 dirname /usr/bin/sort
13432 dirname /usr/bin//.//
13434 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
13435 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
13442 @node pathchk invocation
13443 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
13446 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
13447 @cindex valid file names, checking for
13448 @cindex portable file names, checking for
13450 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
13453 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13456 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
13457 these conditions is true:
13461 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
13462 (execute) permission,
13464 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
13467 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
13468 its file system's maximum.
13471 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
13472 name could be created under the above conditions.
13474 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13475 Options must precede operands.
13481 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
13482 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
13486 A file name is empty.
13489 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
13490 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
13491 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
13494 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
13495 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
13500 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
13501 that begins with @samp{-}.
13503 @item --portability
13504 @opindex --portability
13505 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
13506 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
13510 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
13514 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
13518 @node mktemp invocation
13519 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
13522 @cindex file names, creating temporary
13523 @cindex directory, creating temporary
13524 @cindex temporary files and directories
13526 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
13527 directories. Synopsis:
13530 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
13533 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
13534 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
13535 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
13536 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
13537 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
13538 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
13539 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
13540 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
13542 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
13543 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
13544 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
13545 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
13546 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
13547 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
13548 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
13549 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
13550 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
13551 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
13552 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
13553 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
13554 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
13556 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
13557 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
13558 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
13561 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
13562 will most likely get different file names):
13567 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
13574 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
13576 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
13578 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
13583 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
13584 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
13585 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
13586 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
13587 directory or fifo could not be created.
13589 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
13591 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
13595 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
13596 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
13597 or else in @file{/tmp}.
13599 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
13600 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
13601 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
13602 > echo ... > "$file"
13608 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
13609 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
13610 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
13620 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13627 @opindex --directory
13628 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
13629 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
13630 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
13631 umask is more restrictive.
13637 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
13638 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
13644 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
13645 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
13646 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
13647 time between generating the name and using it where another process
13648 can create an object by the same name.
13651 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
13654 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
13655 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
13656 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
13657 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
13658 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
13659 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
13660 directories must already exist.
13662 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
13664 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
13665 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
13666 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
13667 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
13668 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
13669 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
13674 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
13675 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
13676 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
13677 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
13678 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
13679 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
13684 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
13688 0 if the file was created,
13693 @node realpath invocation
13694 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
13697 @cindex file names, canonicalization
13698 @cindex symlinks, resolution
13699 @cindex canonical file name
13700 @cindex canonicalize a file name
13704 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
13705 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
13706 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
13709 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13712 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13717 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
13719 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
13720 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
13721 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
13722 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
13723 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
13727 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
13729 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
13730 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
13731 treat it as a directory.
13737 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13738 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13743 @opindex --physical
13744 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13745 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13746 This is the default mode of operation.
13752 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
13754 @item --relative-to=@var{file}
13755 @opindex --relative-to
13757 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified file.
13758 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
13759 pertaining to file existence.
13761 @item --relative-base=@var{base}
13762 @opindex --relative-base
13763 This option is valid when used with @option{--relative-to}, and will restrict
13764 the output of @option{--relative-to} so that relative names are output,
13765 only when @var{file}s are descendants of @var{base}. Otherwise output the
13766 absolute file name. If @option{--relative-to} was not specified, then
13767 the descendants of @var{base} are printed relative to @var{base}. If
13768 @option{--relative-to} is specified, then that directory must be a
13769 descendant of @var{base} for this option to have an effect.
13770 Note: this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e}
13771 options pertaining to file existence. For example:
13774 realpath --relative-to=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13777 realpath --relative-base=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13784 @itemx --no-symlinks
13787 @opindex --no-symlinks
13788 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
13789 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
13790 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
13791 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
13797 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
13801 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
13806 @node Working context
13807 @chapter Working context
13809 @cindex working context
13810 @cindex commands for printing the working context
13812 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
13813 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
13814 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
13817 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
13818 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
13819 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
13820 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
13824 @node pwd invocation
13825 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
13828 @cindex print name of current directory
13829 @cindex current working directory, printing
13830 @cindex working directory, printing
13833 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
13836 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
13839 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13846 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
13847 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
13848 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
13849 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
13854 @opindex --physical
13855 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
13856 components of the printed name will be actual directory names---none
13857 will be symbolic links.
13860 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
13861 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
13862 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
13863 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
13864 environment variable is set.
13866 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
13871 @node stty invocation
13872 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
13875 @cindex change or print terminal settings
13876 @cindex terminal settings
13877 @cindex line settings of terminal
13879 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
13883 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
13884 stty [@var{option}]
13887 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
13888 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
13889 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
13890 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
13891 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
13892 @option{--file} option.
13894 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
13895 the terminal line operation, as described below.
13897 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13904 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
13905 be used in combination with any line settings.
13907 @item -F @var{device}
13908 @itemx --file=@var{device}
13911 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
13912 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
13913 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
13914 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
13915 until the carrier detect line is high if
13916 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
13917 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
13923 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
13924 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
13925 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
13926 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
13930 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
13931 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
13932 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
13933 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
13936 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
13937 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
13938 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
13939 systems, those or other settings also may not
13940 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
13943 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
13944 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
13945 non-POSIX platforms.
13950 * Control:: Control settings
13951 * Input:: Input settings
13952 * Output:: Output settings
13953 * Local:: Local settings
13954 * Combination:: Combination settings
13955 * Characters:: Special characters
13956 * Special:: Special settings
13961 @subsection Control settings
13963 @cindex control settings
13969 @cindex two-way parity
13970 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
13976 @cindex even parity
13977 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
13981 @cindex constant parity
13982 @cindex stick parity
13983 @cindex mark parity
13984 @cindex space parity
13985 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
13986 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
13987 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13994 @cindex character size
13995 @cindex eight-bit characters
13996 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
14001 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
14007 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
14011 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
14015 @cindex modem control
14016 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
14020 @cindex hardware flow control
14021 @cindex flow control, hardware
14022 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
14023 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14027 @cindex hardware flow control
14028 @cindex flow control, hardware
14029 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
14030 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14035 @subsection Input settings
14037 @cindex input settings
14038 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
14043 @cindex breaks, ignoring
14044 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
14048 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
14049 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
14053 @cindex parity, ignoring
14054 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
14058 @cindex parity errors, marking
14059 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
14063 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
14067 @cindex eight-bit input
14068 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
14072 @cindex newline, translating to return
14073 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
14077 @cindex return, ignoring
14078 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
14082 @cindex return, translating to newline
14083 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
14087 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
14088 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
14092 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
14093 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
14094 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
14101 @cindex software flow control
14102 @cindex flow control, software
14103 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
14104 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
14105 empty again. May be negated.
14109 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
14110 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
14111 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
14112 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
14116 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
14117 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14121 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
14122 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
14123 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14128 @subsection Output settings
14130 @cindex output settings
14131 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
14136 Postprocess output. May be negated.
14140 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
14141 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
14142 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
14146 @cindex return, translating to newline
14147 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14151 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
14152 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
14157 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
14162 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14166 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
14167 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
14173 @cindex pad character
14174 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
14175 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
14181 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
14188 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
14194 @opindex tab@var{n}
14195 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
14200 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
14205 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
14210 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
14215 @subsection Local settings
14217 @cindex local settings
14222 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
14223 characters. May be negated.
14227 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
14228 special characters. May be negated.
14232 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
14236 Echo input characters. May be negated.
14242 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
14247 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
14248 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
14252 @cindex newline, echoing
14253 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
14257 @cindex flushing, disabling
14258 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
14259 characters. May be negated.
14263 @cindex case translation
14264 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
14265 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
14266 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14270 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
14271 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
14278 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
14279 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14285 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
14286 @cindex hat notation for control characters
14287 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
14288 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14294 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
14295 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
14296 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
14302 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
14303 each character over high latency links. See also
14304 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1116.txt, Internet RFC 1116}.
14311 Note this setting is currently ignored on GNU/Linux systems.
14318 @subsection Combination settings
14320 @cindex combination settings
14321 Combination settings:
14328 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14329 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14333 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14334 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14338 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14339 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
14343 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
14350 @c This is too long to write inline.
14352 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
14353 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
14354 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
14355 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
14356 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
14360 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
14364 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
14365 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
14366 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
14367 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
14374 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
14375 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
14376 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
14380 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
14384 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14389 @cindex eight-bit characters
14390 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
14391 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
14395 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
14396 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
14400 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14404 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
14411 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14412 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
14416 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
14420 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
14425 @subsection Special characters
14427 @cindex special characters
14428 @cindex characters, special
14430 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
14431 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
14432 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
14433 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
14434 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
14435 any other digit to indicate decimal.
14437 @cindex disabling special characters
14438 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
14439 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
14440 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
14441 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
14442 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
14443 special character to @key{U}.)
14449 Send an interrupt signal.
14453 Send a quit signal.
14457 Erase the last character typed.
14461 Erase the current line.
14465 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
14473 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
14478 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
14482 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
14486 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on Linux. Non-POSIX.
14490 Restart the output after stopping it.
14498 Send a terminal stop signal.
14502 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
14506 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
14510 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
14514 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
14515 character. Non-POSIX.
14520 @subsection Special settings
14522 @cindex special settings
14527 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
14528 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14532 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
14533 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14535 @item ispeed @var{n}
14537 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
14539 @item ospeed @var{n}
14541 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
14545 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
14549 @itemx columns @var{n}
14552 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
14556 @cindex nonblocking @command{stty} setting
14557 Apply settings after first waiting for pending output to be transmitted.
14558 This is enabled by default for GNU @command{stty}.
14559 It is useful to disable this option
14560 in cases where the system may be in a state where serial transmission
14562 For example, if the system has received the @samp{DC3} character
14563 with @code{ixon} (software flow control) enabled, then @command{stty} would
14564 block without @code{-drain} being specified.
14565 May be negated. Non-POSIX.
14571 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
14572 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
14573 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
14574 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
14579 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
14583 Print the terminal speed.
14586 @cindex baud rate, setting
14587 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
14588 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
14589 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
14590 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
14591 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
14608 4000000 where the system supports these.
14609 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
14613 @node printenv invocation
14614 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
14617 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
14618 @cindex environment variables, printing
14620 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
14623 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
14626 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
14627 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
14628 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
14630 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14638 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
14642 0 if all variables specified were found
14643 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
14644 2 if a write error occurred
14648 @node tty invocation
14649 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
14652 @cindex print terminal file name
14653 @cindex terminal file name, printing
14655 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
14656 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
14660 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
14663 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14673 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
14677 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
14681 0 if standard input is a terminal
14682 1 if standard input is not a terminal
14683 2 if given incorrect arguments
14684 3 if a write error occurs
14688 @node User information
14689 @chapter User information
14691 @cindex user information, commands for
14692 @cindex commands for printing user information
14694 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
14695 logins, groups, and so forth.
14698 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
14699 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
14700 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
14701 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
14702 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
14703 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
14707 @node id invocation
14708 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
14711 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
14712 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
14713 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
14715 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
14716 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
14719 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]
14722 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
14723 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
14724 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
14726 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
14727 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
14728 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
14729 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
14730 In addition, if SELinux
14731 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
14732 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
14734 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
14735 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
14737 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
14738 Also see @ref{Common options}.
14745 Print only the group ID.
14751 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
14757 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
14758 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14764 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
14765 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14771 Print only the user ID.
14778 @cindex security context
14779 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
14780 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
14781 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
14782 set the exit status to 1.
14788 Delimit output items with NUL characters.
14789 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
14794 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
14799 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
14800 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
14801 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
14802 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
14803 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
14804 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
14805 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
14807 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
14811 @node logname invocation
14812 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
14815 @cindex printing user's login name
14816 @cindex login name, printing
14817 @cindex user name, printing
14820 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
14821 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14822 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
14823 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
14824 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
14826 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14832 @node whoami invocation
14833 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
14836 @cindex effective user ID, printing
14837 @cindex printing the effective user ID
14839 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
14840 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
14842 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14848 @node groups invocation
14849 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
14852 @cindex printing groups a user is in
14853 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
14855 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
14856 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
14857 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
14859 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
14860 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
14863 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
14866 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
14868 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14871 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
14875 @node users invocation
14876 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
14879 @cindex printing current usernames
14880 @cindex usernames, printing current
14882 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
14883 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
14884 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
14885 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
14886 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
14895 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
14896 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14897 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
14898 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
14900 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14903 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
14904 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
14905 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
14910 @node who invocation
14911 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
14914 @cindex printing current user information
14915 @cindex information, about current users
14917 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
14921 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
14924 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
14926 @cindex remote hostname
14927 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
14928 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
14929 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
14933 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
14934 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14935 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
14936 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
14937 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
14941 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
14942 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
14943 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
14944 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
14947 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
14948 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
14949 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
14950 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14952 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14960 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
14966 Print the date and time of last system boot.
14972 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
14978 Print a line of column headings.
14984 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
14985 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
14989 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
14990 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
14991 automatic dial-up internet access.
14995 Same as @samp{who am i}.
15001 List active processes spawned by init.
15007 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
15008 Overrides all other options.
15013 @opindex --runlevel
15014 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
15018 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
15024 Print last system clock change.
15029 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
15030 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
15031 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
15042 @opindex --writable
15043 @cindex message status
15044 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
15045 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
15048 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
15049 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
15050 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
15055 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
15056 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
15057 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
15062 @node System context
15063 @chapter System context
15065 @cindex system context
15066 @cindex context, system
15067 @cindex commands for system context
15069 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
15073 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
15074 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
15075 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
15076 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
15077 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
15078 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
15079 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
15082 @node date invocation
15083 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
15086 @cindex time, printing or setting
15087 @cindex printing the current time
15092 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
15093 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
15094 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
15098 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
15099 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
15100 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
15101 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
15104 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
15105 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
15106 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
15107 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
15109 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
15110 @cindex time formats
15111 @cindex formatting times
15112 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
15113 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
15114 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
15115 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
15116 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
15117 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
15123 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
15124 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
15125 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
15126 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
15127 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
15128 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
15130 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
15132 * Examples of date:: Examples.
15135 @node Time conversion specifiers
15136 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
15138 @cindex time conversion specifiers
15139 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
15141 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
15145 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
15147 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
15149 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
15150 This is a GNU extension.
15152 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
15153 This is a GNU extension.
15155 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
15157 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
15158 This is a GNU extension.
15160 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
15161 blank in many locales.
15162 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
15164 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
15165 This is a GNU extension.
15167 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
15169 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
15171 @cindex epoch, seconds since
15172 @cindex seconds since the epoch
15173 @cindex beginning of time
15174 @cindex leap seconds
15175 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC@.
15176 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
15177 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
15178 This is a GNU extension.
15180 @cindex leap seconds
15181 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
15182 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
15184 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
15186 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
15188 @w{RFC 2822/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone
15189 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
15190 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
15191 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
15192 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
15193 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
15194 by the @option{--date} option.
15196 @w{RFC 3339/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone with
15197 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
15198 zone is determinable.
15199 This is a GNU extension.
15201 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
15202 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
15204 This is a GNU extension.
15206 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
15207 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
15208 no time zone is determinable.
15209 This is a GNU extension.
15211 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
15212 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
15216 @node Date conversion specifiers
15217 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
15219 @cindex date conversion specifiers
15220 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
15222 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
15226 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
15228 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
15230 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
15232 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
15234 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
15236 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
15237 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
15238 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
15239 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
15241 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
15243 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
15245 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
15247 full date in ISO 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15248 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
15249 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
15252 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
15253 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
15254 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
15256 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
15258 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
15259 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
15261 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
15263 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
15264 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
15265 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
15269 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
15271 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
15273 quarter of year (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{4})
15275 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
15277 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
15278 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15279 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
15281 ISO week number, that is, the
15282 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
15283 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15284 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
15285 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
15286 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
15289 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
15291 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
15292 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15293 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
15295 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
15297 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
15299 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
15300 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
15301 precedes year @samp{0000}.
15305 @node Literal conversion specifiers
15306 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
15308 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
15309 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
15311 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
15323 @node Padding and other flags
15324 @subsection Padding and other flags
15326 @cindex numeric field padding
15327 @cindex padding of numeric fields
15328 @cindex fields, padding numeric
15330 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
15331 with zeros, so that, for
15332 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
15333 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
15334 since there is no natural width for them.
15336 As a GNU extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
15337 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
15341 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
15344 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
15345 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
15347 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
15348 would normally pad with spaces.
15350 Use upper case characters if possible.
15352 Use opposite case characters if possible.
15353 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
15357 Here are some examples of padding:
15360 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
15362 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
15364 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
15368 As a GNU extension, you can specify the field width
15369 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
15370 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
15371 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
15372 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
15373 a field of width 9.
15375 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
15376 specification. The modifiers are:
15380 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
15381 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
15382 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
15383 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
15387 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
15388 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
15391 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
15392 is available, it is ignored.
15395 @node Setting the time
15396 @subsection Setting the time
15398 @cindex setting the time
15399 @cindex time setting
15400 @cindex appropriate privileges
15402 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
15403 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
15404 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
15405 system clock. Note for changes to persist across a reboot, the
15406 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
15407 might not happen automatically on your system.
15409 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
15422 first two digits of year (optional)
15424 last two digits of year (optional)
15429 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
15430 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
15431 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
15432 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
15435 @node Options for date
15436 @subsection Options for @command{date}
15438 @cindex @command{date} options
15439 @cindex options for @command{date}
15441 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15445 @item -d @var{datestr}
15446 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
15449 @cindex parsing date strings
15450 @cindex date strings, parsing
15451 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
15454 @opindex next @var{day}
15455 @opindex last @var{day}
15456 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
15457 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
15458 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
15459 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
15460 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
15461 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
15462 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
15463 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
15464 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
15466 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
15468 @xref{Date input formats}.
15472 @cindex debugging date strings
15473 @cindex date strings, debugging
15474 @cindex arbitrary date strings, debugging
15475 annotate the parsed date, display the effective time zone, and warn about
15478 @item -f @var{datefile}
15479 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
15482 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
15483 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
15484 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
15485 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
15488 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
15489 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15490 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
15491 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15492 Display the date using the ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15494 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
15495 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
15498 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
15501 Append the hour of the day to the date.
15504 Append the hours and minutes.
15507 Append the hours, minutes and seconds.
15510 Append the hours, minutes, seconds and nanoseconds.
15513 If showing any time terms, then include the time zone using the format
15515 @macro dateParseNote
15516 This format is always suitable as input
15517 for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
15518 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
15522 @item -r @var{file}
15523 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
15525 @opindex --reference
15526 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
15527 instead of the current date and time.
15534 @opindex --rfc-2822
15535 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
15536 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
15540 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15543 This format conforms to
15544 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
15546 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
15547 current and previous standards for Internet email.
15549 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15550 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15551 Display the date using a format specified by
15552 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
15553 RFC 3339}. This is a subset of the ISO 8601
15554 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
15555 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times.
15558 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
15559 It can be one of the following:
15563 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
15564 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15567 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
15568 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
15569 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
15570 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is equivalent to
15571 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
15574 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
15575 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
15576 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
15580 @item -s @var{datestr}
15581 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
15584 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
15585 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
15592 @opindex --universal
15593 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
15595 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
15597 @cindex leap seconds
15599 Use Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) by operating as if the
15600 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
15602 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
15603 historical reasons.
15604 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
15605 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
15609 @node Examples of date
15610 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
15612 @cindex examples of @command{date}
15614 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
15615 option in the previous section.
15620 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
15623 date --date='2 days ago'
15627 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
15630 date --date='3 months 1 day'
15634 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
15637 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
15641 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
15647 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
15648 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
15649 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
15652 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
15653 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
15654 @samp{-} flag to suppress
15655 the padding altogether:
15658 date -d 1may '+%B %-d'
15662 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
15663 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
15666 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
15670 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
15673 date --set='+2 minutes'
15677 To print the date in RFC 2822 format,
15678 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
15681 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15684 @anchor{%s-examples}
15686 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
15687 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
15688 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
15689 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
15690 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
15694 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
15698 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
15699 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
15700 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
15701 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
15702 seconds) behind UTC:
15705 # local time zone used
15706 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
15711 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
15712 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
15713 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
15714 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
15717 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
15721 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
15722 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
15723 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
15724 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
15725 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
15728 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
15732 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
15733 a more readable form, use a command like this:
15736 # local time zone used
15737 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15738 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15741 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
15742 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
15745 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
15746 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15749 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
15752 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15753 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
15757 @cindex leap seconds
15758 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
15759 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
15760 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
15761 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
15763 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
15764 2012-06-30 23:59:60 UTC:
15767 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
15768 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15770 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15771 date: invalid date '2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000'
15772 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15777 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
15778 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15780 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15782 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15789 @node arch invocation
15790 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
15793 @cindex print machine hardware name
15794 @cindex system information, printing
15796 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
15797 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
15801 arch [@var{option}]
15804 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
15806 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
15807 not rely on its existence.
15812 @node nproc invocation
15813 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
15816 @cindex Print the number of processors
15817 @cindex system information, printing
15819 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
15820 which may be less than the number of online processors.
15821 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
15822 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is
15823 set, then it will determine the returned value. The result is guaranteed to be
15824 greater than zero. Synopsis:
15827 nproc [@var{option}]
15830 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15836 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
15837 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
15838 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is not honored in this case.
15840 @item --ignore=@var{number}
15842 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
15849 @node uname invocation
15850 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
15853 @cindex print system information
15854 @cindex system information, printing
15856 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
15857 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
15858 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
15861 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
15864 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
15865 printed in this order:
15868 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
15869 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
15872 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
15873 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
15874 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
15878 @result{} Linux dumdum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686@c
15879 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
15883 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15891 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
15892 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
15895 @itemx --hardware-platform
15897 @opindex --hardware-platform
15898 @cindex implementation, hardware
15899 @cindex hardware platform
15900 @cindex platform, hardware
15901 Print the hardware platform name
15902 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
15903 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15904 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15910 @cindex machine type
15911 @cindex hardware class
15912 @cindex hardware type
15913 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
15919 @opindex --nodename
15922 @cindex network node name
15923 Print the network node hostname.
15928 @opindex --processor
15929 @cindex host processor type
15930 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
15931 architecture or ISA).
15932 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15933 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15936 @itemx --operating-system
15938 @opindex --operating-system
15939 @cindex operating system name
15940 Print the name of the operating system.
15943 @itemx --kernel-release
15945 @opindex --kernel-release
15946 @cindex kernel release
15947 @cindex release of kernel
15948 Print the kernel release.
15951 @itemx --kernel-name
15953 @opindex --kernel-name
15954 @cindex kernel name
15955 @cindex name of kernel
15956 Print the kernel name.
15957 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
15958 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
15959 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
15960 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
15961 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
15962 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
15963 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
15967 @itemx --kernel-version
15969 @opindex --kernel-version
15970 @cindex kernel version
15971 @cindex version of kernel
15972 Print the kernel version.
15979 @node hostname invocation
15980 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
15983 @cindex setting the hostname
15984 @cindex printing the hostname
15985 @cindex system name, printing
15986 @cindex appropriate privileges
15988 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
15989 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
15990 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
15994 hostname [@var{name}]
15997 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16000 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
16001 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
16002 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
16007 @node hostid invocation
16008 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
16011 @cindex printing the host identifier
16013 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
16014 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
16015 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
16016 @xref{Common options}.
16018 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
16025 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
16026 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
16029 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
16030 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
16035 @node uptime invocation
16036 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
16039 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
16041 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
16042 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
16044 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
16045 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
16046 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
16047 the default setting).
16049 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
16050 @xref{Common options}.
16052 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
16056 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
16059 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
16060 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
16061 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
16062 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
16063 those processes which are waiting for disk I/O). The Linux kernel
16064 includes uninterruptible processes.
16066 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
16067 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
16068 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
16069 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
16073 @node SELinux context
16074 @chapter SELinux context
16076 @cindex SELinux context
16077 @cindex SELinux, context
16078 @cindex commands for SELinux context
16080 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
16084 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
16085 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
16088 @node chcon invocation
16089 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
16092 @cindex changing security context
16093 @cindex change SELinux context
16095 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
16099 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
16100 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
16101 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
16102 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
16105 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
16106 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
16107 to that of @var{rfile}.
16109 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16113 @item --dereference
16114 @opindex --dereference
16115 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
16118 @itemx --no-dereference
16120 @opindex --no-dereference
16121 @cindex no dereference
16122 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
16124 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
16125 @opindex --reference
16126 @cindex reference file
16127 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
16132 @opindex --recursive
16133 Operate on files and directories recursively.
16135 @item --preserve-root
16136 @opindex --preserve-root
16137 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
16138 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
16139 @xref{Treating / specially}.
16141 @item --no-preserve-root
16142 @opindex --no-preserve-root
16143 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
16144 recursively; this is the default.
16145 @xref{Treating / specially}.
16148 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
16151 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
16154 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
16161 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
16163 @item -u @var{user}
16164 @itemx --user=@var{user}
16167 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
16169 @item -r @var{role}
16170 @itemx --role=@var{role}
16173 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
16175 @item -t @var{type}
16176 @itemx --type=@var{type}
16179 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
16181 @item -l @var{range}
16182 @itemx --range=@var{range}
16185 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
16191 @node runcon invocation
16192 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
16195 @cindex run with security context
16198 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
16202 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
16203 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
16204 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
16207 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
16208 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
16209 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
16211 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
16212 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
16213 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
16214 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
16216 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
16219 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16227 Compute process transition context before modifying.
16229 @item -u @var{user}
16230 @itemx --user=@var{user}
16233 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
16235 @item -r @var{role}
16236 @itemx --role=@var{role}
16239 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
16241 @item -t @var{type}
16242 @itemx --type=@var{type}
16245 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
16247 @item -l @var{range}
16248 @itemx --range=@var{range}
16251 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
16255 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
16259 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16260 127 if @command{runcon} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
16261 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16264 @node Modified command invocation
16265 @chapter Modified command invocation
16267 @cindex modified command invocation
16268 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
16269 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
16271 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
16272 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
16276 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
16277 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
16278 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
16279 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
16280 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
16281 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
16285 @node chroot invocation
16286 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
16289 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
16290 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
16292 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
16293 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
16294 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
16295 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
16296 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
16297 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
16298 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
16299 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
16300 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
16304 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16305 chroot @var{option}
16308 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
16309 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
16310 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
16311 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
16312 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
16313 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
16314 @option{-i} option.
16315 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
16316 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16318 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16319 Options must precede operands.
16323 @item --groups=@var{groups}
16325 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
16326 used by the new process.
16327 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
16328 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
16329 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
16331 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
16332 @opindex --userspec
16333 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
16334 as the invoking process.
16335 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
16336 different primary @var{group}.
16337 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
16338 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
16339 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
16342 @opindex --skip-chdir
16343 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
16344 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
16345 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
16346 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
16347 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
16351 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
16352 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
16353 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
16354 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
16355 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
16356 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
16358 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
16359 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
16360 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
16361 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
16362 your new root directory.
16364 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
16365 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
16368 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
16371 Then you'll see output like this:
16376 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
16379 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
16380 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
16381 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
16382 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
16383 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
16384 device files), copy them into place, too.
16386 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
16387 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
16390 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
16394 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
16395 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16396 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16397 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16401 @node env invocation
16402 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
16405 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
16406 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
16407 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
16409 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
16412 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
16413 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16417 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
16418 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
16419 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
16420 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
16421 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
16422 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
16424 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
16425 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
16426 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
16427 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
16428 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
16429 work well with other names.
16432 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
16433 specifies the program to invoke; it is
16434 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
16435 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
16436 The program should not be a special built-in utility
16437 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16439 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
16440 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
16441 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
16442 such as @file{/bin}.
16444 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
16445 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
16446 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
16447 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
16448 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
16451 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16452 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
16453 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16454 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
16455 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
16458 @cindex environment, printing
16460 If no command name is specified following the environment
16461 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
16462 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
16464 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
16465 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
16466 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
16471 Output the current environment.
16473 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
16476 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
16480 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
16481 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
16483 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
16487 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
16488 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
16489 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
16496 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
16497 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
16498 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
16500 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
16504 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
16505 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
16506 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
16507 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
16509 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
16515 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16516 Options must precede operands.
16522 @item -u @var{name}
16523 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
16526 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
16531 @itemx --ignore-environment
16534 @opindex --ignore-environment
16535 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
16539 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
16543 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
16544 125 if @command{env} itself fails
16545 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16546 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16547 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16551 @node nice invocation
16552 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
16556 @cindex scheduling, affecting
16557 @cindex appropriate privileges
16559 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
16560 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
16561 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
16565 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
16568 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
16569 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
16570 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
16572 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
16573 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
16574 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
16575 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
16576 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
16577 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
16578 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
16579 minimum or maximum supported value.
16581 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
16582 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
16583 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
16584 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
16585 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
16586 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
16587 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
16588 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
16589 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
16591 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16592 built-in utilities}).
16594 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
16596 Note to change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
16597 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
16599 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16600 Options must precede operands.
16603 @item -n @var{adjustment}
16604 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
16606 @opindex --adjustment
16607 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
16608 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
16609 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
16612 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
16613 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
16614 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
16618 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
16619 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
16620 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16622 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
16626 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
16627 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
16628 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16629 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16630 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16633 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
16636 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
16639 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
16640 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
16642 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
16653 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
16654 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
16655 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
16659 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
16663 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
16664 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
16667 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
16671 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
16675 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
16677 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
16682 @node nohup invocation
16683 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
16686 @cindex hangups, immunity to
16687 @cindex immunity to hangups
16688 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
16691 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
16692 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
16696 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16699 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
16700 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
16701 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
16702 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
16703 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
16704 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16705 0>/dev/null} instead.
16708 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
16709 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
16710 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
16711 command is not run.
16712 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
16713 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
16714 regardless of the current umask settings.
16716 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
16717 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
16718 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
16719 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
16720 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
16722 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
16723 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
16727 nohup make > make.log
16730 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
16731 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
16732 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
16733 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
16734 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
16736 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16737 built-in utilities}).
16739 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16740 options}. Options must precede operands.
16742 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
16746 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
16747 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16748 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16749 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16752 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
16756 @node stdbuf invocation
16757 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
16760 @cindex standard streams, buffering
16761 @cindex line buffered
16763 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
16764 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
16767 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
16770 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
16773 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
16774 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
16777 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
16778 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
16781 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
16784 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16788 @item -i @var{mode}
16789 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
16792 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
16794 @item -o @var{mode}
16795 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
16798 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
16800 @item -e @var{mode}
16801 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
16804 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
16808 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
16813 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
16814 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
16815 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
16816 This option is invalid with standard input.
16819 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
16820 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
16821 amount of data requested is read from input.
16822 Note the difference in function for input and output.
16823 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
16824 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
16825 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
16826 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
16829 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
16830 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
16834 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
16835 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
16836 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
16839 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
16843 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
16844 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16845 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16846 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16850 @node timeout invocation
16851 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
16855 @cindex run commands with bounded time
16857 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
16858 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
16861 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16864 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16865 built-in utilities}).
16867 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16868 Options must precede operands.
16871 @item --preserve-status
16872 @opindex --preserve-status
16873 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
16874 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
16875 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
16878 @opindex --foreground
16879 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
16880 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
16881 This is needed to support timing out commands not started
16882 directly from an interactive shell, in two situations.
16885 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
16887 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
16888 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
16891 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
16892 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
16893 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
16894 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
16895 themselves (like GDB for example).
16897 @item -k @var{duration}
16898 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
16900 @opindex --kill-after
16901 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
16902 signal, after the specified @var{duration}. Without this option, if the
16903 selected signal proves not to be fatal, @command{timeout} does not kill
16906 @item -s @var{signal}
16907 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
16910 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
16911 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
16912 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
16916 @var{duration} is a floating point number followed by an optional unit:
16918 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
16919 @samp{m} for minutes
16923 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
16924 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
16925 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
16927 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
16931 124 if @var{command} times out
16932 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
16933 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16934 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16935 137 if @var{command} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
16936 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16940 @node Process control
16941 @chapter Process control
16943 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
16944 @cindex commands for controlling processes
16947 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
16951 @node kill invocation
16952 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
16955 @cindex send a signal to processes
16957 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
16958 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
16959 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
16962 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
16963 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
16966 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
16968 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
16969 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
16970 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
16971 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
16972 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
16974 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
16975 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
16976 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
16977 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
16978 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
16979 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
16980 value of @var{pid}.
16982 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
16983 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
16986 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
16987 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
16988 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
16989 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
16998 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
16999 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
17001 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
17002 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
17003 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
17004 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
17005 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
17006 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
17007 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
17008 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
17009 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
17010 and if there is no output error.
17012 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
17013 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
17015 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
17016 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
17017 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
17018 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
17019 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
17020 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
17021 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
17022 signal names and numbers.
17027 @cindex delaying commands
17028 @cindex commands for delaying
17030 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
17033 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
17037 @node sleep invocation
17038 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
17041 @cindex delay for a specified time
17043 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
17044 the values of the command line arguments.
17048 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
17052 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
17053 is seconds. The units are:
17066 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
17067 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
17068 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
17069 arbitrary floating point numbers. @xref{Floating point}.
17071 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
17074 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
17075 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
17080 @node Numeric operations
17081 @chapter Numeric operations
17083 @cindex numeric operations
17084 These programs do numerically-related operations.
17087 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
17088 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
17089 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
17093 @node factor invocation
17094 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
17097 @cindex prime factors
17099 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
17102 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
17103 factor @var{option}
17106 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
17107 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
17109 The @command{factor} command supports only a small number of options:
17113 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
17117 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
17121 Factoring the product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes
17122 takes about 30 milliseconds of CPU time on a 2.2 GHz Athlon.
17125 M8=$(echo 2^31-1|bc)
17126 M9=$(echo 2^61-1|bc)
17127 n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
17128 /usr/bin/time -f %U factor $n
17129 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
17133 Similarly, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256}+1} takes
17134 about 20 seconds on the same machine.
17136 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard-Brent rho
17137 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
17138 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
17139 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
17140 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
17142 If @command{factor} is built without using GNU MP, only
17143 single-precision arithmetic is available, and so large numbers
17144 (typically @math{2^{128}} and above) will not be supported.
17145 The single-precision code uses an algorithm which is designed
17146 for factoring smaller numbers.
17151 @node numfmt invocation
17152 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
17156 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
17157 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
17158 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
17161 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
17164 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
17165 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
17166 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
17167 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
17171 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
17173 @subsection General options
17175 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17181 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
17184 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
17186 @opindex --delimiter
17187 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
17188 @emph{Note}: Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
17190 @item --field=@var{fields}
17192 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
17193 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
17196 N N'th field, counted from 1
17197 N- from N'th field, to end of line
17198 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
17199 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
17204 @item --format=@var{format}
17206 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
17207 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
17208 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
17209 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
17210 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
17211 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
17212 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
17213 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
17214 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
17216 @item --from=@var{unit}
17218 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
17219 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
17222 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
17223 @opindex --from-unit
17224 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
17225 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
17226 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
17227 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
17230 @opindex --grouping
17231 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
17232 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
17233 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
17235 @item --header[=@var{n}]
17237 @opindex --header=N
17238 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
17240 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
17242 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
17243 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
17244 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
17245 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
17246 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
17247 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
17249 @item --padding=@var{n}
17251 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
17252 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
17253 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
17254 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
17256 @item --round=@var{method}
17258 @opindex --round=up
17259 @opindex --round=down
17260 @opindex --round=from-zero
17261 @opindex --round=towards-zero
17262 @opindex --round=nearest
17263 When converting number representations, round the number according to
17264 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
17265 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
17267 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
17269 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
17272 @item --to=@var{unit}
17274 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
17275 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
17277 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
17279 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
17280 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
17281 bytes in blocks of 1KB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
17282 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
17285 @newlineFieldSeparator
17289 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
17291 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
17292 @option{--to=UNITS}:
17297 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
17298 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
17299 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
17302 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
17304 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17305 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
17306 one of the following suffixes:
17309 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo)
17310 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
17311 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
17312 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
17313 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
17314 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
17315 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
17316 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
17320 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17321 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17322 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17323 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17324 one of the following suffixes:
17327 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17328 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17329 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17330 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17331 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17332 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17333 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17334 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17337 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
17338 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
17339 (e.g @samp{Gi}) - but in practice, this method common. Compare with
17340 the @option{iec-i} option.
17343 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17344 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17345 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17346 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17347 one of the following suffixes:
17350 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17351 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17352 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17353 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17354 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17355 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17356 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17357 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17360 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
17361 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
17362 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
17365 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
17366 with @samp{K},@samp{M},@samp{G},@samp{T},@samp{P},@samp{E},@samp{Z},@samp{Y}
17367 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with @samp{Ki},
17368 @samp{Mi},@samp{Gi},@samp{Ti},@samp{Pi},@samp{Ei},@samp{Zi},@samp{Yi} suffixes
17369 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
17373 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
17375 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
17377 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
17380 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
17383 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
17386 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
17389 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
17392 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
17393 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
17395 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
17399 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a harddisk capacity is
17400 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
17404 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
17409 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
17410 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
17411 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
17412 output sizes in human-readable format):
17415 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
17416 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
17417 -rw-r--r-- 1 94K Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
17418 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7K Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
17419 -rw-r--r-- 1 36K Jun 1 2011 COPYING
17420 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
17422 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
17423 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
17424 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
17425 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
17426 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
17427 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
17431 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
17434 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
17435 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
17441 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
17442 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
17448 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17449 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
17455 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17456 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
17463 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
17464 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
17468 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17471 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17474 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17477 $ LC_ALL=C ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17480 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17483 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
17486 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17487 == 2,14,74,83,648==
17491 @node seq invocation
17492 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
17495 @cindex numeric sequences
17496 @cindex sequence of numbers
17498 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
17501 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
17502 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
17503 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
17506 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
17507 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
17508 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
17509 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
17510 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
17511 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
17512 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
17513 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
17514 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
17515 @var{increment} must not be @samp{0}; use @command{yes} to get
17516 repeated output of a constant number.
17517 @var{first}, @var{increment} and @var{last} must not be @code{NaN}.
17518 Floating-point numbers may be specified. @xref{Floating point}.
17520 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17521 Options must precede operands.
17524 @item -f @var{format}
17525 @itemx --format=@var{format}
17528 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
17529 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
17530 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
17531 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
17532 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
17533 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
17534 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
17535 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
17536 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
17537 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
17538 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
17540 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
17541 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
17542 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
17543 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
17544 the default format is @samp{%g}.
17546 @item -s @var{string}
17547 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
17549 @opindex --separator
17550 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
17551 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
17552 The output always terminates with a newline.
17555 @itemx --equal-width
17557 @opindex --equal-width
17558 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
17559 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
17560 decimal representation.
17561 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
17565 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
17568 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
17574 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
17575 to perform the conversion:
17578 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
17584 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
17585 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
17588 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
17594 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
17597 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
17598 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
17599 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
17600 @xref{Floating point}. A common
17601 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
17602 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
17605 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
17606 50000000000000000000
17607 50000000000000000000
17608 50000000000000000004
17611 However, note that when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
17612 an increment of 1 and no format-specifying option, seq can print
17613 arbitrarily large numbers.
17615 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
17616 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
17617 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
17618 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
17621 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
17624 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
17629 @node File permissions
17630 @chapter File permissions
17633 @include parse-datetime.texi
17637 @node Opening the software toolbox
17638 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
17640 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
17641 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
17642 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
17643 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
17646 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
17647 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
17648 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
17649 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
17650 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
17651 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
17652 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
17656 @node Toolbox introduction
17657 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
17659 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
17660 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
17662 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
17663 of program development and usage.
17665 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
17666 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
17667 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
17668 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
17669 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
17670 for solving many kinds of problems.
17672 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
17673 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
17674 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
17675 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
17676 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
17678 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
17679 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
17680 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
17681 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
17682 with the handle of his screwdriver.
17684 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
17685 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
17686 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
17691 difficult to write,
17694 difficult to maintain and
17698 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
17701 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
17702 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
17703 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
17705 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
17706 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
17707 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
17708 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
17709 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
17710 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
17711 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
17712 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
17713 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
17715 @node I/O redirection
17716 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
17718 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
17719 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
17720 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
17721 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
17722 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
17723 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
17724 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
17725 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
17726 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
17729 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
17732 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
17735 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
17736 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
17737 it is in the desired form.
17739 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
17740 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
17741 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
17742 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
17743 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
17744 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
17745 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
17746 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
17747 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
17749 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
17750 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
17751 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
17752 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
17753 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
17754 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
17755 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
17756 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
17757 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
17758 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
17759 data with a text editor.)
17761 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
17762 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
17763 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
17764 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
17765 for the full story.
17767 @node The who command
17768 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
17770 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
17771 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
17772 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
17777 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
17778 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
17779 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
17780 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
17783 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
17784 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
17785 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
17786 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
17787 but the data is not all that exciting.
17789 @node The cut command
17790 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
17792 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
17793 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
17794 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
17795 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
17799 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
17802 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
17805 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
17806 @print{} root:Operator
17808 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
17809 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
17813 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
17814 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
17815 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
17816 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
17818 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
17829 @node The sort command
17830 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
17832 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
17833 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
17834 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
17837 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
17838 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
17839 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
17840 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
17841 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
17844 @node The uniq command
17845 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
17847 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
17848 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
17849 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
17850 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
17851 standard input. It prints only one
17852 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
17853 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
17854 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
17857 @node Putting the tools together
17858 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
17860 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
17861 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
17863 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
17864 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
17867 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
17868 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
17869 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
17870 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
17871 by generating just a list of logged on users:
17881 Next, sort the list:
17884 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
17891 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
17894 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17900 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
17901 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
17902 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
17904 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
17906 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
17907 or @code{root}, prompt):
17910 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
17911 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17913 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
17916 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
17917 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
17918 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
17919 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
17920 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
17921 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
17922 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
17925 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
17926 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
17927 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
17929 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
17930 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
17931 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
17933 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
17934 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
17935 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
17938 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
17939 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
17941 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
17942 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
17943 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
17947 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
17948 @print{} this example has mixed case!
17951 There are several options of interest:
17955 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
17956 operations apply to characters not in the given set
17959 delete characters in the first set from the output
17962 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
17965 We will be using all three options in a moment.
17967 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
17968 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
17969 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
17970 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
17971 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
17972 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
17973 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
17995 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
17996 instead of a regular file.
17998 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
17999 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
18002 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
18003 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
18006 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
18009 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
18010 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
18014 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
18017 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
18018 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
18019 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
18020 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
18021 good measure in a production script.)
18023 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
18024 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
18025 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
18026 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
18029 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
18030 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
18033 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
18034 multiple newline characters in the output into just one, removing
18035 blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
18036 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
18037 typing in all of a command.)
18039 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
18040 case. We're ready to count each word:
18043 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
18044 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
18047 At this point, the data might look something like this:
18060 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
18061 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
18062 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
18066 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
18069 reverse the order of the sort
18072 The final pipeline looks like this:
18075 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
18076 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
18085 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
18086 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
18087 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
18088 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
18090 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
18091 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
18092 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
18093 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
18094 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
18095 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
18096 revision of this article.}
18097 this is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
18099 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
18100 a sorted list of words, one per line:
18103 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
18104 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
18107 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
18108 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
18111 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
18112 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
18113 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
18116 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
18117 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
18118 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
18119 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
18120 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
18121 spelling checker on Unix.
18123 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
18127 search files for text that matches a regular expression
18130 count lines, words, characters
18133 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
18136 the stream editor, an advanced tool
18139 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
18142 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
18143 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
18144 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
18145 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
18151 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
18154 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
18155 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
18156 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
18159 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
18160 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
18163 Let someone else do the hard part.
18166 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
18167 appropriate tool, build one.
18170 As of this writing, all the programs discussed are available from
18171 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/old-gnu/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz},
18172 with more recent versions available from
18173 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/coreutils}.
18175 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
18176 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
18177 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
18178 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
18179 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
18180 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
18181 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
18182 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
18183 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
18186 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
18187 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
18188 still in print and are well worth
18189 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
18190 how I view programming.
18192 The programs in both books are available from
18193 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
18194 For a number of years, there was an active
18195 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
18196 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
18197 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
18198 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
18200 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
18201 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
18202 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
18203 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
18204 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
18206 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
18207 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
18209 @node GNU Free Documentation License
18210 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
18214 @node Concept index
18221 @c Local variables:
18222 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32